aboutsummaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'lib/libmicrohttpd/doc')
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Doxyfile252
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.am32
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.in767
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/basicauthentication.inc207
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/bibliography.inc29
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/exploringrequests.inc103
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/hellobrowser.inc203
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/introduction.inc17
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/largerpost.inc299
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/processingpost.inc231
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/responseheaders.inc177
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/tlsauthentication.inc130
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/ecos.texi420
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/basicauthentication.c182
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/hellobrowser.c39
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/largepost.c227
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/logging.c43
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/responseheaders.c116
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/simplepost.c186
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/tlsauthentication.c258
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/fdl-1.3.texi506
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/lgpl.texi561
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/libmicrohttpd.340
-rwxr-xr-xlib/libmicrohttpd/doc/mdate-sh205
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/microhttpd.texi1498
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/texinfo.tex9291
-rw-r--r--lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/tutorial.texi147
27 files changed, 0 insertions, 16166 deletions
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Doxyfile b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Doxyfile
deleted file mode 100644
index 1563b84c68..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Doxyfile
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,252 +0,0 @@
-# Doxyfile 1.5.5
-
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# Project related configuration options
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-DOXYFILE_ENCODING = UTF-8
-PROJECT_NAME = "GNU libmicrohttpd"
-PROJECT_NUMBER = 0.4.2
-OUTPUT_DIRECTORY = doc/doxygen/
-CREATE_SUBDIRS = YES
-OUTPUT_LANGUAGE = English
-BRIEF_MEMBER_DESC = YES
-REPEAT_BRIEF = YES
-ABBREVIATE_BRIEF = "The $name class" \
- "The $name widget" \
- "The $name file" \
- is \
- provides \
- specifies \
- contains \
- represents \
- a \
- an \
- the
-ALWAYS_DETAILED_SEC = NO
-INLINE_INHERITED_MEMB = NO
-FULL_PATH_NAMES = YES
-STRIP_FROM_PATH = /home/grothoff/svn/libmicrohttpd/
-STRIP_FROM_INC_PATH =
-SHORT_NAMES = NO
-JAVADOC_AUTOBRIEF = NO
-QT_AUTOBRIEF = NO
-MULTILINE_CPP_IS_BRIEF = NO
-DETAILS_AT_TOP = NO
-INHERIT_DOCS = NO
-SEPARATE_MEMBER_PAGES = NO
-TAB_SIZE = 8
-ALIASES =
-OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_FOR_C = YES
-OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_JAVA = NO
-OPTIMIZE_FOR_FORTRAN = NO
-OPTIMIZE_OUTPUT_VHDL = NO
-BUILTIN_STL_SUPPORT = NO
-CPP_CLI_SUPPORT = NO
-SIP_SUPPORT = NO
-DISTRIBUTE_GROUP_DOC = NO
-SUBGROUPING = YES
-TYPEDEF_HIDES_STRUCT = NO
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# Build related configuration options
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-EXTRACT_ALL = YES
-EXTRACT_PRIVATE = NO
-EXTRACT_STATIC = YES
-EXTRACT_LOCAL_CLASSES = NO
-EXTRACT_LOCAL_METHODS = YES
-EXTRACT_ANON_NSPACES = NO
-HIDE_UNDOC_MEMBERS = NO
-HIDE_UNDOC_CLASSES = NO
-HIDE_FRIEND_COMPOUNDS = NO
-HIDE_IN_BODY_DOCS = NO
-INTERNAL_DOCS = NO
-CASE_SENSE_NAMES = YES
-HIDE_SCOPE_NAMES = NO
-SHOW_INCLUDE_FILES = YES
-INLINE_INFO = YES
-SORT_MEMBER_DOCS = YES
-SORT_BRIEF_DOCS = NO
-SORT_GROUP_NAMES = NO
-SORT_BY_SCOPE_NAME = NO
-GENERATE_TODOLIST = NO
-GENERATE_TESTLIST = NO
-GENERATE_BUGLIST = NO
-GENERATE_DEPRECATEDLIST= NO
-ENABLED_SECTIONS =
-MAX_INITIALIZER_LINES = 30
-SHOW_USED_FILES = YES
-SHOW_DIRECTORIES = YES
-FILE_VERSION_FILTER =
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to warning and progress messages
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-QUIET = NO
-WARNINGS = YES
-WARN_IF_UNDOCUMENTED = YES
-WARN_IF_DOC_ERROR = YES
-WARN_NO_PARAMDOC = NO
-WARN_FORMAT = "$file:$line: $text"
-WARN_LOGFILE =
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the input files
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-INPUT = /home/grothoff/svn/libmicrohttpd/src/include \
- /home/grothoff/svn/libmicrohttpd/src/daemon
-INPUT_ENCODING = UTF-8
-FILE_PATTERNS = *.c \
- *.h
-RECURSIVE = YES
-EXCLUDE = /home/grothoff/svn/libmicrohttpd/src/daemon/daemon_test.c \
- /home/grothoff/svn/libmicrohttpd/src/daemon/postprocessor_test.c
-EXCLUDE_SYMLINKS = NO
-EXCLUDE_PATTERNS =
-EXCLUDE_SYMBOLS = MHD_DLOG
-EXAMPLE_PATH =
-EXAMPLE_PATTERNS = *
-EXAMPLE_RECURSIVE = NO
-IMAGE_PATH =
-INPUT_FILTER =
-FILTER_PATTERNS =
-FILTER_SOURCE_FILES = NO
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to source browsing
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-SOURCE_BROWSER = YES
-INLINE_SOURCES = NO
-STRIP_CODE_COMMENTS = YES
-REFERENCED_BY_RELATION = YES
-REFERENCES_RELATION = YES
-REFERENCES_LINK_SOURCE = YES
-USE_HTAGS = NO
-VERBATIM_HEADERS = NO
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the alphabetical class index
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-ALPHABETICAL_INDEX = YES
-COLS_IN_ALPHA_INDEX = 5
-IGNORE_PREFIX =
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the HTML output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_HTML = YES
-HTML_OUTPUT = html
-HTML_FILE_EXTENSION = .html
-HTML_HEADER =
-HTML_FOOTER =
-HTML_STYLESHEET =
-HTML_ALIGN_MEMBERS = YES
-GENERATE_HTMLHELP = NO
-GENERATE_DOCSET = NO
-DOCSET_FEEDNAME = "Doxygen generated docs"
-DOCSET_BUNDLE_ID = org.doxygen.Project
-HTML_DYNAMIC_SECTIONS = NO
-CHM_FILE =
-HHC_LOCATION =
-GENERATE_CHI = NO
-BINARY_TOC = NO
-TOC_EXPAND = NO
-DISABLE_INDEX = NO
-ENUM_VALUES_PER_LINE = 4
-GENERATE_TREEVIEW = YES
-TREEVIEW_WIDTH = 250
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the LaTeX output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_LATEX = NO
-LATEX_OUTPUT = latex
-LATEX_CMD_NAME = latex
-MAKEINDEX_CMD_NAME = makeindex
-COMPACT_LATEX = NO
-PAPER_TYPE = a4wide
-EXTRA_PACKAGES =
-LATEX_HEADER =
-PDF_HYPERLINKS = YES
-USE_PDFLATEX = YES
-LATEX_BATCHMODE = NO
-LATEX_HIDE_INDICES = NO
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the RTF output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_RTF = NO
-RTF_OUTPUT = rtf
-COMPACT_RTF = NO
-RTF_HYPERLINKS = NO
-RTF_STYLESHEET_FILE =
-RTF_EXTENSIONS_FILE =
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the man page output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_MAN = NO
-MAN_OUTPUT = man
-MAN_EXTENSION = .3
-MAN_LINKS = NO
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the XML output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_XML = NO
-XML_OUTPUT = xml
-XML_SCHEMA =
-XML_DTD =
-XML_PROGRAMLISTING = YES
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options for the AutoGen Definitions output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_AUTOGEN_DEF = NO
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# configuration options related to the Perl module output
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-GENERATE_PERLMOD = NO
-PERLMOD_LATEX = NO
-PERLMOD_PRETTY = YES
-PERLMOD_MAKEVAR_PREFIX =
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# Configuration options related to the preprocessor
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-ENABLE_PREPROCESSING = YES
-MACRO_EXPANSION = NO
-EXPAND_ONLY_PREDEF = NO
-SEARCH_INCLUDES = YES
-INCLUDE_PATH =
-INCLUDE_FILE_PATTERNS =
-PREDEFINED =
-EXPAND_AS_DEFINED =
-SKIP_FUNCTION_MACROS = YES
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# Configuration::additions related to external references
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-TAGFILES =
-GENERATE_TAGFILE =
-ALLEXTERNALS = NO
-EXTERNAL_GROUPS = YES
-PERL_PATH = /usr/bin/perl
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# Configuration options related to the dot tool
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-CLASS_DIAGRAMS = YES
-MSCGEN_PATH =
-HIDE_UNDOC_RELATIONS = YES
-HAVE_DOT = YES
-CLASS_GRAPH = NO
-COLLABORATION_GRAPH = NO
-GROUP_GRAPHS = NO
-UML_LOOK = NO
-TEMPLATE_RELATIONS = NO
-INCLUDE_GRAPH = YES
-INCLUDED_BY_GRAPH = YES
-CALL_GRAPH = YES
-CALLER_GRAPH = YES
-GRAPHICAL_HIERARCHY = NO
-DIRECTORY_GRAPH = YES
-DOT_IMAGE_FORMAT = png
-DOT_PATH =
-DOTFILE_DIRS =
-DOT_GRAPH_MAX_NODES = 25
-MAX_DOT_GRAPH_DEPTH = 2
-DOT_TRANSPARENT = YES
-DOT_MULTI_TARGETS = NO
-GENERATE_LEGEND = YES
-DOT_CLEANUP = YES
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-# Configuration::additions related to the search engine
-#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
-SEARCHENGINE = NO
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.am b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.am
deleted file mode 100644
index f25dee7ad9..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.am
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,32 +0,0 @@
-man_MANS = libmicrohttpd.3
-EXTRA_DIST = $(man_MANS) Doxyfile
-
-DISTCLEANFILES = \
- microhttpd.cps \
- microhttpd.dvi \
- tutorial.cps \
- tutorial.dvi
-info_TEXINFOS = \
- microhttpd.texi \
- tutorial.texi
-microhttpd_TEXINFOS = \
- chapters/basicauthentication.inc \
- chapters/bibliography.inc \
- chapters/exploringrequests.inc \
- chapters/hellobrowser.inc \
- chapters/introduction.inc \
- chapters/largerpost.inc \
- chapters/processingpost.inc \
- chapters/responseheaders.inc \
- chapters/tlsauthentication.inc \
- examples/basicauthentication.c \
- examples/hellobrowser.c \
- examples/largepost.c \
- examples/logging.c \
- examples/responseheaders.c \
- examples/simplepost.c \
- examples/tlsauthentication.c \
- fdl-1.3.texi \
- lgpl.texi \
- ecos.texi
-
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.in b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.in
deleted file mode 100644
index 70279a4d61..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/Makefile.in
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,767 +0,0 @@
-# Makefile.in generated by automake 1.11.1 from Makefile.am.
-# @configure_input@
-
-# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
-# 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation,
-# Inc.
-# This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
-# gives unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it,
-# with or without modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
-
-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, to the extent permitted by law; without
-# even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A
-# PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
-
-@SET_MAKE@
-VPATH = @srcdir@
-pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@
-pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@
-pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@
-pkglibexecdir = $(libexecdir)/@PACKAGE@
-am__cd = CDPATH="$${ZSH_VERSION+.}$(PATH_SEPARATOR)" && cd
-install_sh_DATA = $(install_sh) -c -m 644
-install_sh_PROGRAM = $(install_sh) -c
-install_sh_SCRIPT = $(install_sh) -c
-INSTALL_HEADER = $(INSTALL_DATA)
-transform = $(program_transform_name)
-NORMAL_INSTALL = :
-PRE_INSTALL = :
-POST_INSTALL = :
-NORMAL_UNINSTALL = :
-PRE_UNINSTALL = :
-POST_UNINSTALL = :
-build_triplet = @build@
-host_triplet = @host@
-subdir = doc
-DIST_COMMON = $(microhttpd_TEXINFOS) $(srcdir)/Makefile.am \
- $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(srcdir)/stamp-vti \
- $(srcdir)/version.texi mdate-sh texinfo.tex
-ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4
-am__aclocal_m4_deps = $(top_srcdir)/m4/libcurl.m4 \
- $(top_srcdir)/m4/libgcrypt.m4 $(top_srcdir)/m4/libtool.m4 \
- $(top_srcdir)/m4/ltoptions.m4 $(top_srcdir)/m4/ltsugar.m4 \
- $(top_srcdir)/m4/ltversion.m4 $(top_srcdir)/m4/lt~obsolete.m4 \
- $(top_srcdir)/acinclude.m4 $(top_srcdir)/configure.ac
-am__configure_deps = $(am__aclocal_m4_deps) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES) \
- $(ACLOCAL_M4)
-mkinstalldirs = $(install_sh) -d
-CONFIG_HEADER = $(top_builddir)/MHD_config.h
-CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES =
-CONFIG_CLEAN_VPATH_FILES =
-SOURCES =
-DIST_SOURCES =
-INFO_DEPS = $(srcdir)/microhttpd.info \
- $(srcdir)/microhttpd-tutorial.info
-am__TEXINFO_TEX_DIR = $(srcdir)
-DVIS = microhttpd.dvi tutorial.dvi
-PDFS = microhttpd.pdf tutorial.pdf
-PSS = microhttpd.ps tutorial.ps
-HTMLS = microhttpd.html tutorial.html
-TEXINFOS = microhttpd.texi tutorial.texi
-TEXI2DVI = texi2dvi
-TEXI2PDF = $(TEXI2DVI) --pdf --batch
-MAKEINFOHTML = $(MAKEINFO) --html
-AM_MAKEINFOHTMLFLAGS = $(AM_MAKEINFOFLAGS)
-DVIPS = dvips
-am__installdirs = "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)"
-am__vpath_adj_setup = srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`;
-am__vpath_adj = case $$p in \
- $(srcdir)/*) f=`echo "$$p" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
- *) f=$$p;; \
- esac;
-am__strip_dir = f=`echo $$p | sed -e 's|^.*/||'`;
-am__install_max = 40
-am__nobase_strip_setup = \
- srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's/[].[^$$\\*|]/\\\\&/g'`
-am__nobase_strip = \
- for p in $$list; do echo "$$p"; done | sed -e "s|$$srcdirstrip/||"
-am__nobase_list = $(am__nobase_strip_setup); \
- for p in $$list; do echo "$$p $$p"; done | \
- sed "s| $$srcdirstrip/| |;"' / .*\//!s/ .*/ ./; s,\( .*\)/[^/]*$$,\1,' | \
- $(AWK) 'BEGIN { files["."] = "" } { files[$$2] = files[$$2] " " $$1; \
- if (++n[$$2] == $(am__install_max)) \
- { print $$2, files[$$2]; n[$$2] = 0; files[$$2] = "" } } \
- END { for (dir in files) print dir, files[dir] }'
-am__base_list = \
- sed '$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;s/\n/ /g' | \
- sed '$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;$$!N;s/\n/ /g'
-man3dir = $(mandir)/man3
-NROFF = nroff
-MANS = $(man_MANS)
-DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(DIST_SOURCES) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST)
-ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@
-AMTAR = @AMTAR@
-AR = @AR@
-AS = @AS@
-AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@
-AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@
-AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@
-AWK = @AWK@
-CC = @CC@
-CCDEPMODE = @CCDEPMODE@
-CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
-CPP = @CPP@
-CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
-CYGPATH_W = @CYGPATH_W@
-DEFS = @DEFS@
-DEPDIR = @DEPDIR@
-DLLTOOL = @DLLTOOL@
-DSYMUTIL = @DSYMUTIL@
-DUMPBIN = @DUMPBIN@
-ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@
-ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@
-ECHO_T = @ECHO_T@
-EGREP = @EGREP@
-EXEEXT = @EXEEXT@
-EXT_LIBS = @EXT_LIBS@
-EXT_LIB_PATH = @EXT_LIB_PATH@
-FGREP = @FGREP@
-GREP = @GREP@
-HAVE_SOCAT = @HAVE_SOCAT@
-HAVE_ZZUF = @HAVE_ZZUF@
-INSTALL = @INSTALL@
-INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
-INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
-INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@
-INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM@
-LD = @LD@
-LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@
-LIBCURL = @LIBCURL@
-LIBCURL_CPPFLAGS = @LIBCURL_CPPFLAGS@
-LIBGCRYPT_CFLAGS = @LIBGCRYPT_CFLAGS@
-LIBGCRYPT_CONFIG = @LIBGCRYPT_CONFIG@
-LIBGCRYPT_LIBS = @LIBGCRYPT_LIBS@
-LIBOBJS = @LIBOBJS@
-LIBS = @LIBS@
-LIBTOOL = @LIBTOOL@
-LIB_VERSION_AGE = @LIB_VERSION_AGE@
-LIB_VERSION_CURRENT = @LIB_VERSION_CURRENT@
-LIB_VERSION_REVISION = @LIB_VERSION_REVISION@
-LIPO = @LIPO@
-LN_S = @LN_S@
-LTLIBOBJS = @LTLIBOBJS@
-MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@
-MHD_LIBDEPS = @MHD_LIBDEPS@
-MHD_LIB_LDFLAGS = @MHD_LIB_LDFLAGS@
-MKDIR_P = @MKDIR_P@
-NM = @NM@
-NMEDIT = @NMEDIT@
-OBJDUMP = @OBJDUMP@
-OBJEXT = @OBJEXT@
-OTOOL = @OTOOL@
-OTOOL64 = @OTOOL64@
-PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@
-PACKAGE_BUGREPORT = @PACKAGE_BUGREPORT@
-PACKAGE_NAME = @PACKAGE_NAME@
-PACKAGE_STRING = @PACKAGE_STRING@
-PACKAGE_TARNAME = @PACKAGE_TARNAME@
-PACKAGE_URL = @PACKAGE_URL@
-PACKAGE_VERSION = @PACKAGE_VERSION@
-PATH_SEPARATOR = @PATH_SEPARATOR@
-PTHREAD_CPPFLAGS = @PTHREAD_CPPFLAGS@
-PTHREAD_LDFLAGS = @PTHREAD_LDFLAGS@
-PTHREAD_LIBS = @PTHREAD_LIBS@
-RANLIB = @RANLIB@
-SED = @SED@
-SET_MAKE = @SET_MAKE@
-SHELL = @SHELL@
-STRIP = @STRIP@
-VERSION = @VERSION@
-_libcurl_config = @_libcurl_config@
-abs_builddir = @abs_builddir@
-abs_srcdir = @abs_srcdir@
-abs_top_builddir = @abs_top_builddir@
-abs_top_srcdir = @abs_top_srcdir@
-ac_ct_CC = @ac_ct_CC@
-ac_ct_DUMPBIN = @ac_ct_DUMPBIN@
-am__include = @am__include@
-am__leading_dot = @am__leading_dot@
-am__quote = @am__quote@
-am__tar = @am__tar@
-am__untar = @am__untar@
-bindir = @bindir@
-build = @build@
-build_alias = @build_alias@
-build_cpu = @build_cpu@
-build_os = @build_os@
-build_vendor = @build_vendor@
-builddir = @builddir@
-datadir = @datadir@
-datarootdir = @datarootdir@
-docdir = @docdir@
-dvidir = @dvidir@
-exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
-host = @host@
-host_alias = @host_alias@
-host_cpu = @host_cpu@
-host_os = @host_os@
-host_vendor = @host_vendor@
-htmldir = @htmldir@
-includedir = @includedir@
-infodir = @infodir@
-install_sh = @install_sh@
-libdir = @libdir@
-libexecdir = @libexecdir@
-localedir = @localedir@
-localstatedir = @localstatedir@
-lt_ECHO = @lt_ECHO@
-mandir = @mandir@
-mkdir_p = @mkdir_p@
-oldincludedir = @oldincludedir@
-pdfdir = @pdfdir@
-prefix = @prefix@
-program_transform_name = @program_transform_name@
-psdir = @psdir@
-sbindir = @sbindir@
-sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@
-srcdir = @srcdir@
-sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@
-target_alias = @target_alias@
-top_build_prefix = @top_build_prefix@
-top_builddir = @top_builddir@
-top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
-man_MANS = libmicrohttpd.3
-EXTRA_DIST = $(man_MANS) Doxyfile
-DISTCLEANFILES = \
- microhttpd.cps \
- microhttpd.dvi \
- tutorial.cps \
- tutorial.dvi
-
-info_TEXINFOS = \
- microhttpd.texi \
- tutorial.texi
-
-microhttpd_TEXINFOS = \
- chapters/basicauthentication.inc \
- chapters/bibliography.inc \
- chapters/exploringrequests.inc \
- chapters/hellobrowser.inc \
- chapters/introduction.inc \
- chapters/largerpost.inc \
- chapters/processingpost.inc \
- chapters/responseheaders.inc \
- chapters/tlsauthentication.inc \
- examples/basicauthentication.c \
- examples/hellobrowser.c \
- examples/largepost.c \
- examples/logging.c \
- examples/responseheaders.c \
- examples/simplepost.c \
- examples/tlsauthentication.c \
- fdl-1.3.texi \
- lgpl.texi \
- ecos.texi
-
-all: all-am
-
-.SUFFIXES:
-.SUFFIXES: .dvi .html .info .pdf .ps .texi
-$(srcdir)/Makefile.in: $(srcdir)/Makefile.am $(am__configure_deps)
- @for dep in $?; do \
- case '$(am__configure_deps)' in \
- *$$dep*) \
- ( cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh ) \
- && { if test -f $@; then exit 0; else break; fi; }; \
- exit 1;; \
- esac; \
- done; \
- echo ' cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu doc/Makefile'; \
- $(am__cd) $(top_srcdir) && \
- $(AUTOMAKE) --gnu doc/Makefile
-.PRECIOUS: Makefile
-Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status
- @case '$?' in \
- *config.status*) \
- cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh;; \
- *) \
- echo ' cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe)'; \
- cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status $(subdir)/$@ $(am__depfiles_maybe);; \
- esac;
-
-$(top_builddir)/config.status: $(top_srcdir)/configure $(CONFIG_STATUS_DEPENDENCIES)
- cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh
-
-$(top_srcdir)/configure: $(am__configure_deps)
- cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh
-$(ACLOCAL_M4): $(am__aclocal_m4_deps)
- cd $(top_builddir) && $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) am--refresh
-$(am__aclocal_m4_deps):
-
-mostlyclean-libtool:
- -rm -f *.lo
-
-clean-libtool:
- -rm -rf .libs _libs
-
-.texi.info:
- restore=: && backupdir="$(am__leading_dot)am$$$$" && \
- am__cwd=`pwd` && $(am__cd) $(srcdir) && \
- rm -rf $$backupdir && mkdir $$backupdir && \
- if ($(MAKEINFO) --version) >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
- for f in $@ $@-[0-9] $@-[0-9][0-9] $(@:.info=).i[0-9] $(@:.info=).i[0-9][0-9]; do \
- if test -f $$f; then mv $$f $$backupdir; restore=mv; else :; fi; \
- done; \
- else :; fi && \
- cd "$$am__cwd"; \
- if $(MAKEINFO) $(AM_MAKEINFOFLAGS) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS) -I $(srcdir) \
- -o $@ $<; \
- then \
- rc=0; \
- $(am__cd) $(srcdir); \
- else \
- rc=$$?; \
- $(am__cd) $(srcdir) && \
- $$restore $$backupdir/* `echo "./$@" | sed 's|[^/]*$$||'`; \
- fi; \
- rm -rf $$backupdir; exit $$rc
-
-.texi.dvi:
- TEXINPUTS="$(am__TEXINFO_TEX_DIR)$(PATH_SEPARATOR)$$TEXINPUTS" \
- MAKEINFO='$(MAKEINFO) $(AM_MAKEINFOFLAGS) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS) -I $(srcdir)' \
- $(TEXI2DVI) $<
-
-.texi.pdf:
- TEXINPUTS="$(am__TEXINFO_TEX_DIR)$(PATH_SEPARATOR)$$TEXINPUTS" \
- MAKEINFO='$(MAKEINFO) $(AM_MAKEINFOFLAGS) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS) -I $(srcdir)' \
- $(TEXI2PDF) $<
-
-.texi.html:
- rm -rf $(@:.html=.htp)
- if $(MAKEINFOHTML) $(AM_MAKEINFOHTMLFLAGS) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS) -I $(srcdir) \
- -o $(@:.html=.htp) $<; \
- then \
- rm -rf $@; \
- if test ! -d $(@:.html=.htp) && test -d $(@:.html=); then \
- mv $(@:.html=) $@; else mv $(@:.html=.htp) $@; fi; \
- else \
- if test ! -d $(@:.html=.htp) && test -d $(@:.html=); then \
- rm -rf $(@:.html=); else rm -Rf $(@:.html=.htp) $@; fi; \
- exit 1; \
- fi
-$(srcdir)/microhttpd.info: microhttpd.texi $(srcdir)/version.texi $(microhttpd_TEXINFOS)
-microhttpd.dvi: microhttpd.texi $(srcdir)/version.texi $(microhttpd_TEXINFOS)
-microhttpd.pdf: microhttpd.texi $(srcdir)/version.texi $(microhttpd_TEXINFOS)
-microhttpd.html: microhttpd.texi $(srcdir)/version.texi $(microhttpd_TEXINFOS)
-$(srcdir)/version.texi: $(srcdir)/stamp-vti
-$(srcdir)/stamp-vti: microhttpd.texi $(top_srcdir)/configure
- @(dir=.; test -f ./microhttpd.texi || dir=$(srcdir); \
- set `$(SHELL) $(srcdir)/mdate-sh $$dir/microhttpd.texi`; \
- echo "@set UPDATED $$1 $$2 $$3"; \
- echo "@set UPDATED-MONTH $$2 $$3"; \
- echo "@set EDITION $(VERSION)"; \
- echo "@set VERSION $(VERSION)") > vti.tmp
- @cmp -s vti.tmp $(srcdir)/version.texi \
- || (echo "Updating $(srcdir)/version.texi"; \
- cp vti.tmp $(srcdir)/version.texi)
- -@rm -f vti.tmp
- @cp $(srcdir)/version.texi $@
-
-mostlyclean-vti:
- -rm -f vti.tmp
-
-maintainer-clean-vti:
- -rm -f $(srcdir)/stamp-vti $(srcdir)/version.texi
-$(srcdir)/microhttpd-tutorial.info: tutorial.texi
-microhttpd-tutorial.dvi: tutorial.texi
-microhttpd-tutorial.pdf: tutorial.texi
-microhttpd-tutorial.html: tutorial.texi
-.dvi.ps:
- TEXINPUTS="$(am__TEXINFO_TEX_DIR)$(PATH_SEPARATOR)$$TEXINPUTS" \
- $(DVIPS) -o $@ $<
-
-uninstall-dvi-am:
- @$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL)
- @list='$(DVIS)'; test -n "$(dvidir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- $(am__strip_dir) \
- echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(dvidir)/$$f'"; \
- rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(dvidir)/$$f"; \
- done
-
-uninstall-html-am:
- @$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL)
- @list='$(HTMLS)'; test -n "$(htmldir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- $(am__strip_dir) \
- echo " rm -rf '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
- rm -rf "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f"; \
- done
-
-uninstall-info-am:
- @$(PRE_UNINSTALL)
- @if test -d '$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)' && \
- (install-info --version && \
- install-info --version 2>&1 | sed 1q | grep -i -v debian) >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
- list='$(INFO_DEPS)'; \
- for file in $$list; do \
- relfile=`echo "$$file" | sed 's|^.*/||'`; \
- echo " install-info --info-dir='$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)' --remove '$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/$$relfile'"; \
- if install-info --info-dir="$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)" --remove "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/$$relfile"; \
- then :; else test ! -f "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/$$relfile" || exit 1; fi; \
- done; \
- else :; fi
- @$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL)
- @list='$(INFO_DEPS)'; \
- for file in $$list; do \
- relfile=`echo "$$file" | sed 's|^.*/||'`; \
- relfile_i=`echo "$$relfile" | sed 's|\.info$$||;s|$$|.i|'`; \
- (if test -d "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)" && cd "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)"; then \
- echo " cd '$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)' && rm -f $$relfile $$relfile-[0-9] $$relfile-[0-9][0-9] $$relfile_i[0-9] $$relfile_i[0-9][0-9]"; \
- rm -f $$relfile $$relfile-[0-9] $$relfile-[0-9][0-9] $$relfile_i[0-9] $$relfile_i[0-9][0-9]; \
- else :; fi); \
- done
-
-uninstall-pdf-am:
- @$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL)
- @list='$(PDFS)'; test -n "$(pdfdir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- $(am__strip_dir) \
- echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f'"; \
- rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)/$$f"; \
- done
-
-uninstall-ps-am:
- @$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL)
- @list='$(PSS)'; test -n "$(psdir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- $(am__strip_dir) \
- echo " rm -f '$(DESTDIR)$(psdir)/$$f'"; \
- rm -f "$(DESTDIR)$(psdir)/$$f"; \
- done
-
-dist-info: $(INFO_DEPS)
- @srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
- list='$(INFO_DEPS)'; \
- for base in $$list; do \
- case $$base in \
- $(srcdir)/*) base=`echo "$$base" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
- esac; \
- if test -f $$base; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
- base_i=`echo "$$base" | sed 's|\.info$$||;s|$$|.i|'`; \
- for file in $$d/$$base $$d/$$base-[0-9] $$d/$$base-[0-9][0-9] $$d/$$base_i[0-9] $$d/$$base_i[0-9][0-9]; do \
- if test -f $$file; then \
- relfile=`expr "$$file" : "$$d/\(.*\)"`; \
- test -f "$(distdir)/$$relfile" || \
- cp -p $$file "$(distdir)/$$relfile"; \
- else :; fi; \
- done; \
- done
-
-mostlyclean-aminfo:
- -rm -rf microhttpd.aux microhttpd.cp microhttpd.cps microhttpd.fn \
- microhttpd.fns microhttpd.ky microhttpd.kys microhttpd.log \
- microhttpd.pg microhttpd.pgs microhttpd.tmp microhttpd.toc \
- microhttpd.tp microhttpd.tps microhttpd.vr microhttpd.vrs \
- tutorial.aux tutorial.cp tutorial.cps tutorial.fn \
- tutorial.fns tutorial.ky tutorial.kys tutorial.log \
- tutorial.pg tutorial.pgs tutorial.tmp tutorial.toc \
- tutorial.tp tutorial.tps tutorial.vr tutorial.vrs
-
-clean-aminfo:
- -test -z "microhttpd.dvi microhttpd.pdf microhttpd.ps microhttpd.html \
- microhttpd-tutorial.dvi microhttpd-tutorial.pdf \
- microhttpd-tutorial.ps microhttpd-tutorial.html" \
- || rm -rf microhttpd.dvi microhttpd.pdf microhttpd.ps microhttpd.html \
- microhttpd-tutorial.dvi microhttpd-tutorial.pdf \
- microhttpd-tutorial.ps microhttpd-tutorial.html
-
-maintainer-clean-aminfo:
- @list='$(INFO_DEPS)'; for i in $$list; do \
- i_i=`echo "$$i" | sed 's|\.info$$||;s|$$|.i|'`; \
- echo " rm -f $$i $$i-[0-9] $$i-[0-9][0-9] $$i_i[0-9] $$i_i[0-9][0-9]"; \
- rm -f $$i $$i-[0-9] $$i-[0-9][0-9] $$i_i[0-9] $$i_i[0-9][0-9]; \
- done
-install-man3: $(man_MANS)
- @$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
- test -z "$(man3dir)" || $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)"
- @list=''; test -n "$(man3dir)" || exit 0; \
- { for i in $$list; do echo "$$i"; done; \
- l2='$(man_MANS)'; for i in $$l2; do echo "$$i"; done | \
- sed -n '/\.3[a-z]*$$/p'; \
- } | while read p; do \
- if test -f $$p; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
- echo "$$d$$p"; echo "$$p"; \
- done | \
- sed -e 'n;s,.*/,,;p;h;s,.*\.,,;s,^[^3][0-9a-z]*$$,3,;x' \
- -e 's,\.[0-9a-z]*$$,,;$(transform);G;s,\n,.,' | \
- sed 'N;N;s,\n, ,g' | { \
- list=; while read file base inst; do \
- if test "$$base" = "$$inst"; then list="$$list $$file"; else \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$file' '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$file" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)/$$inst" || exit $$?; \
- fi; \
- done; \
- for i in $$list; do echo "$$i"; done | $(am__base_list) | \
- while read files; do \
- test -z "$$files" || { \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" || exit $$?; }; \
- done; }
-
-uninstall-man3:
- @$(NORMAL_UNINSTALL)
- @list=''; test -n "$(man3dir)" || exit 0; \
- files=`{ for i in $$list; do echo "$$i"; done; \
- l2='$(man_MANS)'; for i in $$l2; do echo "$$i"; done | \
- sed -n '/\.3[a-z]*$$/p'; \
- } | sed -e 's,.*/,,;h;s,.*\.,,;s,^[^3][0-9a-z]*$$,3,;x' \
- -e 's,\.[0-9a-z]*$$,,;$(transform);G;s,\n,.,'`; \
- test -z "$$files" || { \
- echo " ( cd '$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)' && rm -f" $$files ")"; \
- cd "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)" && rm -f $$files; }
-tags: TAGS
-TAGS:
-
-ctags: CTAGS
-CTAGS:
-
-
-distdir: $(DISTFILES)
- @list='$(MANS)'; if test -n "$$list"; then \
- list=`for p in $$list; do \
- if test -f $$p; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
- if test -f "$$d$$p"; then echo "$$d$$p"; else :; fi; done`; \
- if test -n "$$list" && \
- grep 'ab help2man is required to generate this page' $$list >/dev/null; then \
- echo "error: found man pages containing the \`missing help2man' replacement text:" >&2; \
- grep -l 'ab help2man is required to generate this page' $$list | sed 's/^/ /' >&2; \
- echo " to fix them, install help2man, remove and regenerate the man pages;" >&2; \
- echo " typically \`make maintainer-clean' will remove them" >&2; \
- exit 1; \
- else :; fi; \
- else :; fi
- @srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's/[].[^$$\\*]/\\\\&/g'`; \
- topsrcdirstrip=`echo "$(top_srcdir)" | sed 's/[].[^$$\\*]/\\\\&/g'`; \
- list='$(DISTFILES)'; \
- dist_files=`for file in $$list; do echo $$file; done | \
- sed -e "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||;t" \
- -e "s|^$$topsrcdirstrip/|$(top_builddir)/|;t"`; \
- case $$dist_files in \
- */*) $(MKDIR_P) `echo "$$dist_files" | \
- sed '/\//!d;s|^|$(distdir)/|;s,/[^/]*$$,,' | \
- sort -u` ;; \
- esac; \
- for file in $$dist_files; do \
- if test -f $$file || test -d $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
- if test -d $$d/$$file; then \
- dir=`echo "/$$file" | sed -e 's,/[^/]*$$,,'`; \
- if test -d "$(distdir)/$$file"; then \
- find "$(distdir)/$$file" -type d ! -perm -700 -exec chmod u+rwx {} \;; \
- fi; \
- if test -d $(srcdir)/$$file && test $$d != $(srcdir); then \
- cp -fpR $(srcdir)/$$file "$(distdir)$$dir" || exit 1; \
- find "$(distdir)/$$file" -type d ! -perm -700 -exec chmod u+rwx {} \;; \
- fi; \
- cp -fpR $$d/$$file "$(distdir)$$dir" || exit 1; \
- else \
- test -f "$(distdir)/$$file" \
- || cp -p $$d/$$file "$(distdir)/$$file" \
- || exit 1; \
- fi; \
- done
- $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) \
- top_distdir="$(top_distdir)" distdir="$(distdir)" \
- dist-info
-check-am: all-am
-check: check-am
-all-am: Makefile $(INFO_DEPS) $(MANS)
-installdirs:
- for dir in "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(man3dir)"; do \
- test -z "$$dir" || $(MKDIR_P) "$$dir"; \
- done
-install: install-am
-install-exec: install-exec-am
-install-data: install-data-am
-uninstall: uninstall-am
-
-install-am: all-am
- @$(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) install-exec-am install-data-am
-
-installcheck: installcheck-am
-install-strip:
- $(MAKE) $(AM_MAKEFLAGS) INSTALL_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" \
- install_sh_PROGRAM="$(INSTALL_STRIP_PROGRAM)" INSTALL_STRIP_FLAG=-s \
- `test -z '$(STRIP)' || \
- echo "INSTALL_PROGRAM_ENV=STRIPPROG='$(STRIP)'"` install
-mostlyclean-generic:
-
-clean-generic:
-
-distclean-generic:
- -test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)
- -test . = "$(srcdir)" || test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_VPATH_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_VPATH_FILES)
- -test -z "$(DISTCLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(DISTCLEANFILES)
-
-maintainer-clean-generic:
- @echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use"
- @echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild."
-clean: clean-am
-
-clean-am: clean-aminfo clean-generic clean-libtool mostlyclean-am
-
-distclean: distclean-am
- -rm -f Makefile
-distclean-am: clean-am distclean-generic
-
-dvi: dvi-am
-
-dvi-am: $(DVIS)
-
-html: html-am
-
-html-am: $(HTMLS)
-
-info: info-am
-
-info-am: $(INFO_DEPS)
-
-install-data-am: install-info-am install-man
-
-install-dvi: install-dvi-am
-
-install-dvi-am: $(DVIS)
- @$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
- test -z "$(dvidir)" || $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(dvidir)"
- @list='$(DVIS)'; test -n "$(dvidir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
- echo "$$d$$p"; \
- done | $(am__base_list) | \
- while read files; do \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files '$(DESTDIR)$(dvidir)'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files "$(DESTDIR)$(dvidir)" || exit $$?; \
- done
-install-exec-am:
-
-install-html: install-html-am
-
-install-html-am: $(HTMLS)
- @$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
- test -z "$(htmldir)" || $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)"
- @list='$(HTMLS)'; list2=; test -n "$(htmldir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- if test -f "$$p" || test -d "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
- $(am__strip_dir) \
- if test -d "$$d$$p"; then \
- echo " $(MKDIR_P) '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
- $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f" || exit 1; \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) '$$d$$p'/* '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) "$$d$$p"/* "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)/$$f" || exit $$?; \
- else \
- list2="$$list2 $$d$$p"; \
- fi; \
- done; \
- test -z "$$list2" || { echo "$$list2" | $(am__base_list) | \
- while read files; do \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files '$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files "$(DESTDIR)$(htmldir)" || exit $$?; \
- done; }
-install-info: install-info-am
-
-install-info-am: $(INFO_DEPS)
- @$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
- test -z "$(infodir)" || $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)"
- @srcdirstrip=`echo "$(srcdir)" | sed 's|.|.|g'`; \
- list='$(INFO_DEPS)'; test -n "$(infodir)" || list=; \
- for file in $$list; do \
- case $$file in \
- $(srcdir)/*) file=`echo "$$file" | sed "s|^$$srcdirstrip/||"`;; \
- esac; \
- if test -f $$file; then d=.; else d=$(srcdir); fi; \
- file_i=`echo "$$file" | sed 's|\.info$$||;s|$$|.i|'`; \
- for ifile in $$d/$$file $$d/$$file-[0-9] $$d/$$file-[0-9][0-9] \
- $$d/$$file_i[0-9] $$d/$$file_i[0-9][0-9] ; do \
- if test -f $$ifile; then \
- echo "$$ifile"; \
- else : ; fi; \
- done; \
- done | $(am__base_list) | \
- while read files; do \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files '$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)" || exit $$?; done
- @$(POST_INSTALL)
- @if (install-info --version && \
- install-info --version 2>&1 | sed 1q | grep -i -v debian) >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
- list='$(INFO_DEPS)'; test -n "$(infodir)" || list=; \
- for file in $$list; do \
- relfile=`echo "$$file" | sed 's|^.*/||'`; \
- echo " install-info --info-dir='$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)' '$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/$$relfile'";\
- install-info --info-dir="$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)" "$(DESTDIR)$(infodir)/$$relfile" || :;\
- done; \
- else : ; fi
-install-man: install-man3
-
-install-pdf: install-pdf-am
-
-install-pdf-am: $(PDFS)
- @$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
- test -z "$(pdfdir)" || $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)"
- @list='$(PDFS)'; test -n "$(pdfdir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
- echo "$$d$$p"; \
- done | $(am__base_list) | \
- while read files; do \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files '$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files "$(DESTDIR)$(pdfdir)" || exit $$?; done
-install-ps: install-ps-am
-
-install-ps-am: $(PSS)
- @$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
- test -z "$(psdir)" || $(MKDIR_P) "$(DESTDIR)$(psdir)"
- @list='$(PSS)'; test -n "$(psdir)" || list=; \
- for p in $$list; do \
- if test -f "$$p"; then d=; else d="$(srcdir)/"; fi; \
- echo "$$d$$p"; \
- done | $(am__base_list) | \
- while read files; do \
- echo " $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files '$(DESTDIR)$(psdir)'"; \
- $(INSTALL_DATA) $$files "$(DESTDIR)$(psdir)" || exit $$?; done
-installcheck-am:
-
-maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-am
- -rm -f Makefile
-maintainer-clean-am: distclean-am maintainer-clean-aminfo \
- maintainer-clean-generic maintainer-clean-vti
-
-mostlyclean: mostlyclean-am
-
-mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-aminfo mostlyclean-generic \
- mostlyclean-libtool mostlyclean-vti
-
-pdf: pdf-am
-
-pdf-am: $(PDFS)
-
-ps: ps-am
-
-ps-am: $(PSS)
-
-uninstall-am: uninstall-dvi-am uninstall-html-am uninstall-info-am \
- uninstall-man uninstall-pdf-am uninstall-ps-am
-
-uninstall-man: uninstall-man3
-
-.MAKE: install-am install-strip
-
-.PHONY: all all-am check check-am clean clean-aminfo clean-generic \
- clean-libtool dist-info distclean distclean-generic \
- distclean-libtool distdir dvi dvi-am html html-am info info-am \
- install install-am install-data install-data-am install-dvi \
- install-dvi-am install-exec install-exec-am install-html \
- install-html-am install-info install-info-am install-man \
- install-man3 install-pdf install-pdf-am install-ps \
- install-ps-am install-strip installcheck installcheck-am \
- installdirs maintainer-clean maintainer-clean-aminfo \
- maintainer-clean-generic maintainer-clean-vti mostlyclean \
- mostlyclean-aminfo mostlyclean-generic mostlyclean-libtool \
- mostlyclean-vti pdf pdf-am ps ps-am uninstall uninstall-am \
- uninstall-dvi-am uninstall-html-am uninstall-info-am \
- uninstall-man uninstall-man3 uninstall-pdf-am uninstall-ps-am
-
-
-# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
-# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
-.NOEXPORT:
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/basicauthentication.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/basicauthentication.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index fc2e45caa3..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/basicauthentication.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,207 +0,0 @@
-With the small exception of IP address based access control,
-requests from all connecting clients where served equally until now.
-This chapter discusses a first method of client's authentication and
-its limits.
-
-A very simple approach feasible with the means already discussed would
-be to expect the password in the @emph{URI} string before granting access to
-the secured areas. The password could be separated from the actual resource identifier
-by a certain character, thus the request line might look like
-@verbatim
-GET /picture.png?mypassword
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-In a situation where the client is customized enough and the connection occurs
-through secured lines (e.g., a embedded device directly attached to another via wire),
-this can be a reasonable choice.
-
-But when it is assumed that the user connecting does so with an ordinary Internet browser,
-this implementation brings some problems about. For example, the URI including the password
-stays in the address field or at least in the history of the browser for anybody near enough to see.
-It will also be inconvenient to add the password manually to any new URI when the browser does
-not know how to compose this automatically.
-
-At least the convenience issue can be addressed by employing the simplest built-in password
-facilities of HTTP compliant browsers, hence we want to start there. It will however turn out
-to have still severe weaknesses in terms of security which need consideration.
-
-Before we will start implementing @emph{Basic Authentication} as described in @emph{RFC 2617},
-we should finally abandon the bad practice of responding every request the first time our callback
-is called for a given connection. This is becoming more important now because the client and
-the server will have to talk in a more bi-directional way than before to
-
-But how can we tell whether the callback has been called before for the particular connection?
-Initially, the pointer this parameter references is set by @emph{MHD} in the callback. But it will
-also be "remembered" on the next call (for the same connection).
-Thus, we will generate no response until the parameter is non-null---implying the callback was
-called before at least once. We do not need to share information between different calls of the callback,
-so we can set the parameter to any adress that is assured to be not null. The pointer to the
-@code{connection} structure will be pointing to a legal adress, so we take this.
-
-Not even the headers will be looked at on the first iteration.
-
-@verbatim
-int answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method, const char *version,
- const char *upload_data, size_t *upload_data_size,
- void **con_cls)
-{
- if (0 != strcmp(method, "GET")) return MHD_NO;
- if (NULL == *con_cls) {*con_cls = connection; return MHD_YES;}
-
- ...
- /* else respond accordingly */
- ...
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Note how we lop off the connection on the first condition, but return asking for more on
-the other one with @code{MHD_YES}.
-With the framework improved, we can proceed to implement the actual authentication process.
-
-@heading Request for authentication
-
-Let us assume we had only files not intended to be handed out without the correct username/password,
-so every "GET" request will be challenged.
-@emph{RFC 2617} describes how the server shall ask for authentication by adding a
-@emph{WWW-Authenticate} response header with the name of the @emph{realm} protected.
-
-We let an extra function function do this.
-@verbatim
-int ask_for_authentication (struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *realm)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- char *headervalue;
- const char *strbase = "Basic realm=";
-
- response = MHD_create_response_from_data (0, NULL, MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
- if (!response) return MHD_NO;
-
- headervalue = malloc (strlen (strbase) + strlen (realm) + 1);
- if (!headervalue) return MHD_NO;
-
- strcpy (headervalue, strbase);
- strcat (headervalue, realm);
-
- ret = MHD_add_response_header (response, "WWW-Authenticate", headervalue);
- free (headervalue);
- if (!ret) {MHD_destroy_response (response); return MHD_NO;}
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_UNAUTHORIZED, response);
-
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-@code{#define} the realm name according to your own taste, e.g. "Maintenance" or "Area51" but
-it will need to have extra quotes.
-
-But the client may send the authentication right away, so it would be wrong to ask for
-it without checking the request's header--where the authentication is expected to be found.
-
-@heading Authentication in detail
-Checking @emph{RFC 2617} again, we find that the client will pack the username and password, by
-whatever means he might have obtained them, in a line separated by a colon---and then encodes
-them to @emph{Base64}. The actual implementation of this encoding are not within the scope of
-this tutorial although a working function is included in the complete source file of the example.
-
-An unencoded word describing the authentication method (here "Basic") will precede the code
-and the resulting line is the value of a request header of the type "Authorization".
-
-This header line thus is of interest to the function checking a connection for a given username/password:
-@verbatim
-int is_authenticated (struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *username, const char *password)
-{
- const char *headervalue;
- ...
-
- headervalue = MHD_lookup_connection_value (connection, MHD_HEADER_KIND,
- "Authorization");
- if (NULL == headervalue) return 0;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-where, firstly, the authentication method will be checked.
-@verbatim
-const char *strbase = "Basic ";
-...
-if (0 != strncmp (headervalue, strbase, strlen (strbase))) return 0;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Of course, we could decode the passed credentials in the next step and compare them directly to
-the given strings. But as this would involve string parsing, which is more complicated then string
-composing, it is done the other way around---the clear text credentials will be encoded to @emph{Base64}
-and then compared against the headerline. The authentication method string will be left out here as
-it has been checked already at this point.
-@verbatim
- char *expected_b64, *expected;
- int authenticated;
-
- ...
- strcpy (expected, username);
- strcat (expected, ":");
- strcat (expected, password);
-
- expected_b64 = string_to_base64 (expected);
- if (NULL == expected_b64) return 0;
-
- strcpy (expected, strbase);
- authenticated = (strcmp (headervalue + strlen (strbase), expected_b64) == 0);
-
- free (expected_b64);
-
- return authenticated;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-These two functions---together with a response function in case of positive authentication doing little
-new---allow the rest of the callback function to be rather short.
-@verbatim
- if (!is_authenticated (connection, USER, PASSWORD))
- return ask_for_authentication (connection, REALM);
-
- return secret_page (connection);
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-See the @code{examples} directory for the complete example file.
-
-@heading Remarks
-For a proper server, the conditional statements leading to a return of @code{MHD_NO} should yield a
-response with a more precise status code instead of silently closing the connection. For example,
-failures of memory allocation are best reported as @emph{internal server error} and unexpected
-authentication methods as @emph{400 bad request}.
-
-@heading Exercises
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-Make the server respond to wrong credentials (but else correct requests) with the recommended
-@emph{401 unauthorized} status code. If the client still does not authenticate correctly within the
-same connection, close it and store the client's IP address for a certain time. (It is OK to check for
-expiration not until the main thread wakes up again on the next connection.) If the client fails
-authenticating three times during this period, add it to another list whose entries the
-@code{AcceptPolicyCallback} function denies connection (temporally).
-
-@item
-With the network utility @emph{netcat} connect and log the response of a "GET" request as you
-did in the exercise of the first example, this time to a file. Now stop the server and let @emph{netcat}
-listen on the same port the server used to listen on and have it fake being the proper server by giving
-the file's content as the response (e.g. @code{cat log | nc -l -p 8888}). Pretending to think your were
-connecting to the actual server, browse to the eavesdropper and give the correct credentials.
-
-Copy and paste the encoded string you see in netcat's output to some of the Base64 decode tools available online
-and see how both the user's name and password could be completely restored.
-
-@end itemize
-
-
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/bibliography.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/bibliography.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index cc288bc085..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/bibliography.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,29 +0,0 @@
-@heading API reference
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-The @emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} manual by Marco Maggi and Christian Grothoff 2008
-@uref{http://gnunet.org/libmicrohttpd/microhttpd.html}
-
-@item
-All referenced RFCs can be found on the website of @emph{The Internet Engineering Task Force}
-@uref{http://www.ietf.org/}
-
-@item
-@emph{RFC 2616}: Fielding, R., Gettys, J., Mogul, J., Frystyk, H., and T. Berners-Lee,
-"Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1", RFC 2016, January 1997.
-
-@item
-@emph{RFC 2617}: Franks, J., Hallam-Baker, P., Hostetler, J., Lawrence, S., Leach, P.,
-Luotonen, A., and L. Stewart, "HTTP Authentication: Basic and Digest Access Authentication", RFC 2617, June 1999.
-
-
-@item
-A well--structured @emph{HTML} reference can be found on
-@uref{http://www.echoecho.com/html.htm}
-
-For those readers understanding German or French, there is an excellent document both for learning
-@emph{HTML} and for reference, whose English version unfortunately has been discontinued.
-@uref{http://de.selfhtml.org/} and @uref{http://fr.selfhtml.org/}
-
-
-@end itemize
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/exploringrequests.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/exploringrequests.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index d87900251f..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/exploringrequests.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,103 +0,0 @@
-This chapter will deal with the information which the client sends to the
-server at every request. We are going to examine the most useful fields of such an request
-and print them out in a readable manner. This could be useful for logging facilities.
-
-The starting point is the @emph{hellobrowser} program with the former response removed.
-
-This time, we just want to collect information in the callback function, thus we will
-just return MHD_NO after we have probed the request. This way, the connection is closed
-without much ado by the server.
-
-@verbatim
-int answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- ...
- return MHD_NO;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-The ellipsis marks the position where the following instructions shall be inserted.
-
-
-We begin with the most obvious information available to the server, the request line. You should
-already have noted that a request consists of a command (or "method") and a URI (e.g. a filename).
-It also contains a string for the version of the protocol which can be found in @code{version}.
-To call it a "new request" is justified because we return only @code{MHD_NO}, thus ensuring the
-function will not be called again for this connection.
-@verbatim
-printf ("New request %s for %s using version %s\n", method, url, version);
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-The rest of the information is a bit more hidden. Nevertheless, there is lot of it sent from common
-Internet browsers. It is stored in "key-name" pairs and we want to list what we find in the header.
-As there is no mandatory set of keys a client has to send, each key--name pair is printed out one by
-one until there are no more left. We do this by writing a separate function which will be called for
-each pair just like the above function is called for each HTTP request.
-It can then print out the content of this pair.
-@verbatim
-int print_out_key (void *cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key, const char *value)
-{
- printf ("%s = %s\n", key, value);
- return MHD_YES;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-To start the iteration process that calls our new function for every key, the line
-@verbatim
-MHD_get_connection_values (connection, MHD_HEADER_KIND, print_out_key, NULL);
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-needs to be inserted in the connection callback function too. The second parameter tells the function
-that we are only interested in keys from the general HTTP header of the request. Our iterating
-function @code{PrintOutKey} does not rely on any additional information to fulfill its duties
-so the last parameter can be NULL.
-
-All in all, this constitutes the complete @code{logger.c} program for this chapter which can be
-found in the @code{examples} section.
-
-Connecting with any modern Internet browser should yield a handful of keys. You should try to
-interpret them with the aid of @emph{RFC 2616}.
-Especially worth mentioning is the host key which is often used to serve several different websites
-hosted under one single IP address but reachable by different domain names.
-
-@heading Conclusion
-The introduced capabilities to itemize the content of a simple GET request---especially the
-URI---should already allow the server to satisfy clients' requests for small specific resources
-(e.g. files) or even induce alteration of how the server operates. However, the latter is not
-recommended as the GET method (including its header data) is by convention considered a "SAFE"
-operation, which should not change the server's state in a significant way, but temporally actions
-like searching for a passed string is fine.
-
-Of course, no transmission can occur while the return value is still set to @code{MHD_NO} in the
-callback function.
-
-@heading Exercises
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-By parsing the @code{url} string and delivering responses accordingly, implement a small server for
-"virtual" files. When asked for @code{/index.htm@{l@}}, let the response consist of a HTML page
-containing a link to @code{/another.html} page which is also to be created "on the fly" in case of
-being requested. If neither of these two pages are requested, @code{MHD_HTTP_NOT_FOUND} shall be
-returned accompanied by an informative message.
-
-@item
-A very interesting information has still been ignored by our logger---the client's IP address.
-Implement a callback function
-@verbatim
-int on_client_connect (void *cls,
- const struct sockaddr *addr,socklen_t addrlen)
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-that prints out the IP address in an appropriate format. You might want to use the posix function
-@code{inet_ntoa} but bear in mind that @code{addr} is actually just a structure containing other
-substructures and is @emph{not} the variable this function expects.
-Make sure to return @code{MHD_YES} so that the library knows the client is allowed to connect
-(and to request). If one wanted to limit access basing on IP addresses, this would be the place
-to do it. The address of your function will then be passed as the third parameter of the
-@code{MHD_start_daemon} call.
-
-@end itemize
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/hellobrowser.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/hellobrowser.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index 444fcd8e38..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/hellobrowser.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,203 +0,0 @@
-The most basic task for a HTTP server is to deliver a static text message to any client connecting to it.
-Given that this is also easy to implement, it is an excellent problem to start with.
-
-For now, the particular filename the client asks for shall have no effect on the message that will
-be returned. In addition, the server shall end the connection after the message has been sent so that
-the client will know there is nothing more to expect.
-
-The C program @code{hellobrowser.c}, which is to be found in the examples section, does just that.
-If you are very eager, you can compile and start it right away but it is advisable to type the
-lines in by yourself as they will be discussed and explained in detail.
-
-After the necessary includes and the definition of the port which our server should listen on
-@verbatim
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-the desired behaviour of our server when HTTP request arrive has to be implemented. We already have
-agreed that it should not care about the particular details of the request, such as who is requesting
-what. The server will respond merely with the same small HTML page to every request.
-
-The function we are going to write now will be called by @emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} every time an
-appropriate request comes in. While the name of this callback function is arbitrary, its parameter
-list has to follow a certain layout. So please, ignore the lot of parameters for now, they will be
-explained at the point they are needed. We have to use only one of them,
-@code{struct MHD_Connection *connection}, for the minimalistic functionality we want to archive at the moment.
-
-This parameter is set by the @emph{libmicrohttpd} daemon and holds the necessary information to
-relate the call with a certain connection. Keep in mind that a server might have to satisfy hundreds
-of concurrent connections and we have to make sure that the correct data is sent to the destined
-client. Therefore, this variable is a means to refer to a particular connection if we ask the
-daemon to sent the reply.
-
-Talking about the reply, it is defined as a string right after the function header
-@verbatim
-int answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- const char *page = "<html><body>Hello, browser!</body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-HTTP is a rather strict protocol and the client would certainly consider it "inappropriate" if we
-just sent the answer string "as is". Instead, it has to be wrapped in certain layers, called headers,
-of additional information. Luckily, most of the work in this area is done by the library for us---we
-just have to ask. Our reply string packed in the necessary layers will be called a "response".
-To obtain such a response we hand our data (the reply--string) and its size over to the
-@code{MHD_create_response_from_data} function. The last two parameters basically tell @emph{MHD}
-that we do not want it to dispose the message data for us when it has been sent and there also needs
-no internal copy to be done because the @emph{constant} string won't change anyway.
-
-@verbatim
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- int ret;
-
- response = MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page),
- (void*) page, MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-Now that the the response has been laced up, it is ready for delivery and can be queued for sending.
-This is done by passing it to another @emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} function. As all our work was done in
-the scope of one function, the recipient is without doubt the one associated with the
-local variable @code{connection} and consequently this variable is given to the queue function.
-Every HTTP response is accompanied by a status code, here "OK", so that the client knows
-this response is the intended result of his request and not due to some error or malfunction.
-
-Finally, the packet is destroyed and the return value from the queue returned,
-already being set at this point to either MHD_YES or MHD_NO in case of success or failure.
-
-@verbatim
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-With the primary task of our server implemented, we can start the actual server daemon which will listen
-on @code{PORT} for connections. This is done in the main function.
-@verbatim
-int main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon) return 1;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-The first parameter is one of three possible modes of operation. Here we want the daemon to run in
-a separate thread and to manage all incoming connections in the same thread. This means that while
-producing the response for one connection, the other connections will be put on hold. In this
-chapter, where the reply is already known and therefore the request is served quickly, this poses no problem.
-
-We will allow all clients to connect regardless of their name or location, therefore we do not check
-them on connection and set the forth and fifth parameter to NULL.
-
-Parameter six is the address of the function we want to be called whenever a new connection has been
-established. Our @code{AnswerToConnection} knows best what the client wants and needs no additional
-information (which could be passed via the next parameter) so the next parameter is NULL. Likewise,
-we do not need to pass extra options to the daemon so we just write the MHD_OPTION_END as the last parameter.
-
-As the server daemon runs in the background in its own thread, the execution flow in our main
-function will contine right after the call. Because of this, we must delay the execution flow in the
-main thread or else the program will terminate prematurely. We let it pause in a processing-time
-friendly manner by waiting for the enter key to be pressed. In the end, we stop the daemon so it can
-do its cleanup tasks.
-@verbatim
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
- return 0;
-}
-
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-The first example is now complete.
-
-Compile it with
-@verbatim
-cc hellobrowser.c -o hellobrowser -I$PATH_TO_LIBMHD_INCLUDES
- -L$PATH_TO_LIBMHD_INCLUDES -static -lmicrohttpd -pthread
-@end verbatim
-with the two paths set accordingly and run it.
-
-Now open your favorite Internet browser and go to the address @code{localhost:8888}, provided that
-is the port you chose. If everything works as expected, the browser will present the message of the
-static HTML page it got from our minimal server.
-
-@heading Remarks
-To keep this first example as small as possible, some drastic shortcuts were taken and are to be
-discussed now.
-
-Firstly, there is no distinction made between the kinds of requests a client could send. We implied
-that the client sends a GET request, that means, that he actually asked for some data. Even when
-it is not intended to accept POST requests, a good server should at least recognize that this
-request does not constitute a legal request and answer with an error code. This can be easily
-implemented by checking if the parameter @code{method} equals the string "GET" and returning a
-@code{MHD_NO} if not so.
-
-Secondly, the above practice of queuing a response upon the first call of the callback function
-brings with it some limitations. This is because the content of the message body will not be
-received if a response is queued in the first iteration. Furthermore, the connection will be closed
-right after the response has been transferred then.
-
-Both of these issues you will find addressed in the official @code{minimal_example.c} residing in
-the @code{src/examples} directory of the @emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} package. The source code of this
-program should look very familiar to you by now and easy to understand.
-
-For our example, the @code{must_copy} and @code{must_free} parameter at the response construction
-function could be set to @code{MHD_NO}. In the usual case, responses cannot be sent immediately
-after being queued. For example, there might be other data on the system that needs to be sent with
-a higher priority. Nevertheless, the queue function will return successfully---raising the problem
-that the data we have pointed to may be invalid by the time it is about being sent. This is not an
-issue here because we can expect the @code{page} string, which is a constant @emph{string literal}
-here, to be static. That means it will be present and unchanged for as long as the program runs.
-For dynamic data, one could choose to either have @emph{MHD} free the memory @code{page} points
-to itself when it is not longer needed or, alternatively, have the library to make and manage
-its own copy of it.
-
-@heading Exercises
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-While the server is running, use a program like telnet or netcat to connect to it. Try to form a
-valid HTTP1.1 request yourself like
-@verbatim
-GET /dontcare HTTP1.1
-Host: itsme
-<enter>
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-and see what the server returns to you.
-
-
-@item
-Also, try other requests, like POST, and see how our server does not mind and why.
-How far in malforming a request can you go before the builtin functionality of @emph{MHD} intervenes
-and an altered response is sent? Make sure you read about the status codes in the @emph{RFC}.
-
-
-@item
-Add the option @code{MHD_USE_PEDANTIC_CHECKS} to the start function of the daemon in @code{main}.
-Mind the special format of the parameter list here which is described in the manual. How indulgent
-is the server now to your input?
-
-
-@item
-Let the main function take a string as the first command line argument and pass @code{argv[1]} to
-the @code{MHD_start_daemon} function as the sixth parameter. The address of this string will be
-passed to the callback function via the @code{cls} variable. Decorate the text given at the command
-line when the server is started with proper HTML tags and send it as the response instead of the
-former static string.
-
-
-@item
-@emph{Demanding:} Write a separate function returning a string containing some useful information,
-for example, the time. Pass the function's address as the sixth parameter and evaluate this function
-on every request anew in @code{AnswerToConnection}. Remember to free the memory of the string
-every time after satisfying the request.
-
-@end itemize
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/introduction.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/introduction.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index 722d0fb711..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/introduction.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,17 +0,0 @@
-This tutorial is for developers who want to learn how they can add HTTP serving
-capabilities to their applications with the @emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} library,
-abbreviated @emph{MHD}. The reader will learn how to
-implement basic HTTP functions from simple executable
-sample programs that implement various features.
-
-The text is supposed to be a supplement to the API reference manual of
-@emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} and for that reason does not explain many of the parameters.
-Therefore, the reader should always consult the manual to find the exact meaning
-of the functions used in the tutorial. Furthermore, the reader is
-encouraged to study the relevant @emph{RFCs}, which document the HTTP standard.
-
-@emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} is assumed to be already installed. This tutorial
-is written for version @value{VERSION}. At the time being,
-this tutorial has only been tested on @emph{GNU/Linux} machines even though
-efforts were made not to rely on anything that would prevent the samples from being
-built on similar systems.
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/largerpost.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/largerpost.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index 2cf8c3c030..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/largerpost.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,299 +0,0 @@
-The previous chapter introduced a way to upload data to the server, but the developed example program
-has some shortcomings, such as not being able to handle larger chunks of data. In this chapter, we
-are going to discuss a more advanced server program that allows clients to upload a file in order to
-have it stored on the server's filesystem. The server shall also watch and limit the number of
-clients concurrently uploading, responding with a proper busy message if necessary.
-
-
-@heading Prepared answers
-We choose to operate the server with the @code{SELECT_INTERNALLY} method. This makes it easier to
-synchronize the global states at the cost of possible delays for other connections if the processing
-of a request is too slow. One of these variables that needs to be shared for all connections is the
-total number of clients that are uploading.
-
-@verbatim
-#define MAXCLIENTS 2
-static unsigned char nr_of_uploading_clients = 0;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If there are too many clients uploading, we want the server to respond to all requests with a busy
-message.
-@verbatim
-const char* busypage = "<html><body>This server is busy, please try again later.</body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Otherwise, the server will send a @emph{form} that informs the user of the current number of uploading clients,
-and ask her to pick a file on her local filesystem which is to be uploaded.
-@verbatim
-const char* askpage = "<html><body>\n\
- Upload a file, please!<br>\n\
- There are %d clients uploading at the moment.<br>\n\
- <form action=\"/filepost\" method=\"post\" enctype=\"multipart/form-data\">\n\
- <input name=\"file\" type=\"file\">\n\
- <input type=\"submit\" value=\" Send \"></form>\n\
- </body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If the upload has succeeded, the server will respond with a message saying so.
-@verbatim
-const char* completepage = "<html><body>The upload has been completed.</body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-We want the server to report internal errors, such as memory shortage or file access problems,
-adequately.
-@verbatim
-const char* servererrorpage = "<html><body>An internal server error has occured.</body></html>";
-const char* fileexistspage = "<html><body>This file already exists.</body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-It would be tolerable to send all these responses undifferentiated with a @code{200 HTTP_OK}
-status code but in order to improve the @code{HTTP} conformance of our server a bit, we extend the
-@code{send_page} function so that it accepts individual status codes.
-
-@verbatim
-int send_page (struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char* page, int status_code)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
-
-
- response = MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page), (void*) page, MHD_NO, MHD_YES);
- if (!response) return MHD_NO;
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, status_code, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Note how we ask @emph{MHD} to make its own copy of the message data. The reason behind this will
-become clear later.
-
-
-@heading Connection cycle
-The decision whether the server is busy or not is made right at the beginning of the connection. To
-do that at this stage is especially important for @emph{POST} requests because if no response is
-queued at this point, and @code{MHD_YES} returned, @emph{MHD} will not sent any queued messages until
-a postprocessor has been created and the post iterator is called at least once.
-
-@verbatim
-int answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- if (NULL == *con_cls)
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info;
-
- if (nr_of_uploading_clients >= MAXCLIENTS)
- return send_page(connection, busypage, MHD_HTTP_SERVICE_UNAVAILABLE);
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If the server is not busy, the @code{connection_info} structure is initialized as usual, with
-the addition of a filepointer for each connection.
-
-@verbatim
- con_info = malloc (sizeof (struct connection_info_struct));
- if (NULL == con_info) return MHD_NO;
- con_info->fp = 0;
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- ...
- }
- else con_info->connectiontype = GET;
-
- *con_cls = (void*) con_info;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-For @emph{POST} requests, the postprocessor is created and we register a new uploading client. From
-this point on, there are many possible places for errors to occur that make it necessary to interrupt
-the uploading process. We need a means of having the proper response message ready at all times.
-Therefore, the @code{connection_info} structure is extended to hold the most current response
-message so that whenever a response is sent, the client will get the most informative message. Here,
-the structure is initialized to "no error".
-@verbatim
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- con_info->postprocessor = MHD_create_post_processor (connection, POSTBUFFERSIZE,
- iterate_post, (void*) con_info);
-
- if (NULL == con_info->postprocessor)
- {
- free (con_info);
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- nr_of_uploading_clients++;
-
- con_info->connectiontype = POST;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_OK;
- con_info->answerstring = completepage;
- }
- else con_info->connectiontype = GET;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If the connection handler is called for the second time, @emph{GET} requests will be answered with
-the @emph{form}. We can keep the buffer under function scope, because we asked @emph{MHD} to make its
-own copy of it for as long as it is needed.
-@verbatim
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "GET"))
- {
- int ret;
- char buffer[1024] = {0};
-
- sprintf (buffer, askpage, nr_of_uploading_clients);
- return send_page (connection, buffer, MHD_HTTP_OK);
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-The rest of the @code{answer_to_connection} function is very similar to the @code{simplepost.c}
-example, except the more flexible content of the responses. The @emph{POST} data is processed until
-there is none left and the execution falls through to return an error page if the connection
-constituted no expected request method.
-@verbatim
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = *con_cls;
-
- if (0 != *upload_data_size)
- {
- MHD_post_process(con_info->postprocessor, upload_data, *upload_data_size);
- *upload_data_size = 0;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
- else return send_page (connection, con_info->answerstring, con_info->answercode);
- }
-
- return send_page(connection, errorpage, MHD_HTTP_BAD_REQUEST);
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-@heading Storing to data
-Unlike the @code{simplepost.c} example, here it is to be expected that post iterator will be called
-several times now. This means that for any given connection (there might be several concurrent of them)
-the posted data has to be written to the correct file. That is why we store a file handle in every
-@code{connection_info}, so that the it is preserved between successive iterations.
-@verbatim
-int iterate_post (void *coninfo_cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key,
- const char *filename, const char *content_type,
- const char *transfer_encoding, const char *data, uint64_t off, size_t size)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = (struct connection_info_struct*) coninfo_cls;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Because the following actions depend heavily on correct file processing, which might be error prone,
-we default to reporting internal errors in case anything will go wrong.
-
-@verbatim
-con_info->answerstring = servererrorpage;
-con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_INTERNAL_SERVER_ERROR;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-In the "askpage" @emph{form}, we told the client to label its post data with the "file" key. Anything else
-would be an error.
-
-@verbatim
- if (0 != strcmp (key, "file")) return MHD_NO;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If the iterator is called for the first time, no file will have been opened yet. The @code{filename}
-string contains the name of the file (without any paths) the user selected on his system. We want to
-take this as the name the file will be stored on the server and make sure no file of that name exists
-(or is being uploaded) before we create one.
-@verbatim
- if (!con_info->fp)
- {
- if (NULL != (fp = fopen (filename, "rb")) )
- {
- fclose (fp);
- con_info->answerstring = fileexistspage;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_FORBIDDEN;
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- con_info->fp = fopen (filename, "ab");
- if (!con_info->fp) return MHD_NO;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-Occasionally, the iterator function will be called even when there are 0 new bytes to process. The
-server only needs to write data to the file if there is some.
-@verbatim
-if (size > 0)
- {
- if (!fwrite (data, size, sizeof(char), con_info->fp)) return MHD_NO;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If this point has been reached, everything worked well for this iteration and the response can
-be set to success again. If the upload has finished, this iterator function will not be called again.
-@verbatim
- con_info->answerstring = completepage;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_OK;
-
- return MHD_YES;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-The new client was registered when the postprocessor was created. Likewise, we unregister the client
-on destroying the postprocessor when the request is completed.
-@verbatim
-void request_completed (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, void **con_cls,
- enum MHD_RequestTerminationCode toe)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = (struct connection_info_struct*) *con_cls;
-
- if (NULL == con_info) return;
-
- if (con_info->connectiontype == POST)
- {
- if (NULL != con_info->postprocessor)
- {
- MHD_destroy_post_processor (con_info->postprocessor);
- nr_of_uploading_clients--;
- }
-
- if (con_info->fp) fclose (con_info->fp);
- }
-
- free (con_info);
- *con_cls = NULL;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-This is essentially the whole example @code{largepost.c}.
-
-
-@heading Remarks
-Now that the clients are able to create files on the server, security aspects are becoming even more
-important than before. Aside from proper client authentication, the server should always make sure
-explicitly that no files will be created outside of a dedicated upload directory.
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/processingpost.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/processingpost.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index f1085ce879..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/processingpost.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,231 +0,0 @@
-The previous chapters already have demonstrated a variety of possibilities to send information
-to the HTTP server, but it is not recommended that the @emph{GET} method is used to alter the way
-the server operates. To induce changes on the server, the @emph{POST} method is preferred over
-and is much more powerful than @emph{GET} and will be introduced in this chapter.
-
-We are going to write an application that asks for the visitor's name and, after the user has posted it,
-composes an individual response text. Even though it was not mandatory to use the @emph{post} method here,
-as there is no permanent change caused by the post, it is an illustrative example on how to share data
-between different functions for the same connection. Furthermore, the reader should be able to extend
-it easily.
-
-@heading GET request
-When the first @emph{GET} request arrives, the server shall respond with a HTML page containing an
-edit field for the name.
-
-@verbatim
-const char* askpage = "<html><body>\
- What's your name, Sir?<br>\
- <form action=\"/namepost\" method=\"post\">\
- <input name=\"name\" type=\"text\"\
- <input type=\"submit\" value=\" Send \"></form>\
- </body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-The @code{action} entry is the @emph{URI} to be called by the browser when posting, and the
-@code{name} will be used later to be sure it is the editbox's content that has been posted.
-
-We also prepare the answer page, where the name is to be filled in later, and an error page
-as the response for anything but proper @emph{GET} and @emph{POST} requests:
-
-@verbatim
-const char* greatingpage="<html><body><h1>Welcome, %s!</center></h1></body></html>";
-
-const char* errorpage="<html><body>This doesn't seem to be right.</body></html>";
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Whenever we need to send a page, we use an extra function
-@code{int SendPage(struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char* page)}
-for this, which does not contain anything new and whose implementation is therefore left out here.
-
-
-@heading POST request
-Posted data can be of arbitrary and considerable size; for example, if a user uploads a big
-image to the server. Similar to the case of the header fields, there may also be different streams
-of posted data, such as one containing the text of an editbox and another the state of a button.
-Likewise, we will have to register an iterator function that is going to be called maybe several times
-not only if there are different POSTs but also if one POST has only been received partly yet and
-needs processing before another chunk can be received.
-
-Such an iterator function is called by a @emph{postprocessor}, which must be created upon arriving
-of the post request. We want the iterator function to read the first post data which is tagged
-@code{name} and to create an individual greeting string based on the template and the name.
-But in order to pass this string to other functions and still be able to differentiate different
-connections, we must first define a structure to share the information, holding the most import entries.
-
-@verbatim
-struct connection_info_struct
-{
- int connectiontype;
- char *answerstring;
- struct MHD_PostProcessor *postprocessor;
-};
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-With these information available to the iterator function, it is able to fulfill its task.
-Once it has composed the greeting string, it returns @code{MHD_NO} to inform the post processor
-that it does not need to be called again. Note that this function does not handle processing
-of data for the same @code{key}. If we were to expect that the name will be posted in several
-chunks, we had to expand the namestring dynamically as additional parts of it with the same @code{key}
-came in. But in this example, the name is assumed to fit entirely inside one single packet.
-
-@verbatim
-int iterate_post (void *coninfo_cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key,
- const char *filename, const char *content_type,
- const char *transfer_encoding, const char *data, uint64_t off, size_t size)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = (struct connection_info_struct*) coninfo_cls;
-
-
- if (0 == strcmp (key, "name"))
- {
- if ((size > 0) && (size <= MAXNAMESIZE))
- {
- char *answerstring;
- answerstring = malloc (MAXANSWERSIZE);
- if (!answerstring) return MHD_NO;
-
- snprintf (answerstring, MAXANSWERSIZE, greatingpage, data);
- con_info->answerstring = answerstring;
- }
- else con_info->answerstring = NULL;
-
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- return MHD_YES;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Once a connection has been established, it can be terminated for many reasons. As these
-reasons include unexpected events, we have to register another function that cleans up any resources
-that might have been allocated for that connection by us, namely the post processor and the greetings
-string. This cleanup function must take into account that it will also be called for finished
-requests other than @emph{POST} requests.
-
-@verbatim
-void request_completed (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, void **con_cls,
- enum MHD_RequestTerminationCode toe)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = (struct connection_info_struct*) *con_cls;
-
-
- if (NULL == con_info) return;
-
- if (con_info->connectiontype == POST)
- {
- MHD_destroy_post_processor (con_info->postprocessor);
- if (con_info->answerstring) free (con_info->answerstring);
- }
-
- free (con_info);
- *con_cls = NULL;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-@emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} is informed that it shall call the above function when the daemon is started
-in the main function.
-
-@verbatim
-...
-daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL, MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED,
- request_completed, NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
-...
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-@heading Request handling
-With all other functions prepared, we can now discuss the actual request handling.
-
-On the first iteration for a new request, we start by allocating a new instance of a
-@code{ConnectionInfoStruct} structure, which will store all necessary information for later
-iterations and other functions.
-
-@verbatim
-int answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- if(NULL == *con_cls)
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info;
-
- con_info = malloc (sizeof (struct connection_info_struct));
- if (NULL == con_info) return MHD_NO;
- con_info->answerstring = NULL;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If the new request is a @emph{POST}, the postprocessor must be created now. In addition, the type
-of the request is stored for convenience.
-@verbatim
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- con_info->postprocessor = MHD_create_post_processor (connection, POSTBUFFERSIZE,
- iterate_post, (void*) con_info);
-
- if (NULL == con_info->postprocessor)
- {
- free (con_info);
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- con_info->connectiontype = POST;
- }
- else con_info->connectiontype = GET;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-The address of our structure will both serve as the indicator for successive iterations and to remember
-the particular details about the connection.
-@verbatim
- *con_cls = (void*) con_info;
- return MHD_YES;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-The rest of the function will not be executed on the first iteration. A @emph{GET} request is easily
-satisfied by sending the question form.
-@verbatim
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "GET"))
- {
- return send_page (connection, askpage);
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-In case of @emph{POST}, we invoke the post processor for as long as data keeps incoming, setting
-@code{*upload_data_size} to zero in order to indicate that we have processed---or at least have
-considered---all of it.
-@verbatim
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = *con_cls;
-
- if (*upload_data_size != 0)
- {
- MHD_post_process(con_info->postprocessor, upload_data, *upload_data_size);
- *upload_data_size = 0;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
- else if (NULL != con_info->answerstring) return send_page (connection, con_info->answerstring);
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-If they are neither @emph{GET} nor @emph{POST} requests, the error page is returned finally.
-@verbatim
- return send_page(connection, errorpage);
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-These were the important parts of the program @code{simplepost.c}.
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/responseheaders.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/responseheaders.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index 3fb9ac1562..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/responseheaders.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,177 +0,0 @@
-Now that we are able to inspect the incoming request in great detail,
-this chapter discusses the means to enrich the outgoing responses likewise.
-
-As you have learned in the @emph{Hello, Browser} chapter, some obligatory
-header fields are added and set automatically for simple responses by the library
-itself but if more advanced features are desired, additional fields have to be created.
-One of the possible fields is the content type field and an example will be developed around it.
-This will lead to an application capable of correctly serving different types of files.
-
-
-When we responded with HTML page packed in the static string previously, the client had no choice
-but guessing about how to handle the response, because the server hadn't told him.
-What if we had sent a picture or a sound file? Would the message have been understood
-or merely been displayed as an endless stream of random characters in the browser?
-This is what the mime content types are for. The header of the response is extended
-by certain information about how the data is to be interpreted.
-
-To introduce the concept, a picture of the format @emph{PNG} will be sent to the client
-and labeled accordingly with @code{image/png}.
-Once again, we can base the new example on the @code{hellobrowser} program.
-
-@verbatim
-#define FILENAME "picture.png"
-#define MIMETYPE "image/png"
-
-int answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- unsigned char *buffer = NULL;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-We want the program to load the graphics file into memory:
-@verbatim
- long size;
- FILE *fp;
- int ret = 0;
-
- if (0 != strcmp(method, "GET")) return MHD_NO;
-
- size = get_file_size (FILENAME);
- if (size != 0)
- {
- fp = fopen (FILENAME, "rb");
- if (fp)
- {
- buffer = malloc (size);
-
- if (buffer)
- if (size == fread (buffer, 1, size, fp)) ret = 1;
-
- fclose(fp);
- }
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-The @code{GetFileSize} function, which returns a size of zero if the file could not be opened or
-found, is left out on this page for tidiness.
-
-When dealing with files and allocating memory, there is a lot that could go wrong on the
-server side and if so, the client should be informed with @code{MHD_HTTP_INTERNAL_SERVER_ERROR}.
-
-@verbatim
- if (!ret)
- {
- const char *errorstr = "<html><body>An internal server error has occured!\
- </body></html>";
-
- if (buffer) free(buffer);
-
- response = MHD_create_response_from_data(strlen(errorstr), (void*)errorstr,
- MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
-
- if (response)
- {
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_INTERNAL_SERVER_ERROR, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
- else return MHD_NO;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Note that we nevertheless have to create a response object even for sending a simple error code.
-Otherwise, the connection would just be closed without comment, leaving the client curious about
-what has happened.
-
-But in the case of success a response will be constructed that contains the buffer filled with the
-file's content.
-
-@verbatim
-response = MHD_create_response_from_data (size, (void*)buffer, MHD_YES, MHD_NO);
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-Contrary to the above case where a static string will be sent, this time we have to
-keep track of the dynamically allocated buffer. As discussed in the @ref{Hello browser example},
-the buffer cannot be safely freed as soon as the function call returns. Instead, we ask the function
-to keep charge of freeing the buffer itself when it is not longer needed. Thus, no further @code{free}
-command is invoked by us.
-
-Up to this point, there was little new. The actual novelty is that we enhance the header with the
-meta data about the content. Aware of the field's name we want to add, it is as easy as that:
-@verbatim
-MHD_add_response_header(response, "Content-Type", MIMETYPE);
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-We do not have to append a colon expected by the protocol hehind the first
-field---@emph{GNU libhttpdmicro} will take care of this.
-
-The function finishes with the well-known lines
-@verbatim
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
- return ret;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-The complete program @code{responseheaders.c} is in the @code{examples} section as usual.
-Find a @emph{PNG} file you like and save it to the directory the example is run from under the name
-@code{picture.png}. You should find the image displayed on your browser if everything worked well.
-
-@heading Remarks
-The include file of the @emph{MHD} library comes with the header types mentioned in @emph{RFC 2616}
-already defined as macros. Thus, we could have written @code{MHD_HTTP_HEADER_CONTENT_TYPE} instead
-of @code{"Content-Type"} as well. However, one is not limited to these standard headers and could
-add custom response headers without violating the protocol. Whether, and how, the client would react
-to these custom header is up to the receiver. Likewise, the client is allowed to send custom request
-headers to the server as well, opening up yet more possibilities how client and server could
-communicate with each other.
-
-The method of creating the response from one big chunk of data is only feasible for smaller files.
-A public file server satisfying many request at the same time would be choking under these high
-demands on memory very soon. Serving responses in smaller parts would be more adequate here and
-will be a topic of a future chapter.
-
-@heading Exercises
-@itemize @bullet
-
-@item
-Remember that the original program was written under a few assumptions---a small, static response
-being one of them. In order to simulate a very large or hard to reach file that cannot be provided
-instantly, postpone the queuing in the callback with the @code{sleep} function for 30 seconds
-@emph{if} the file @code{/big.png} is requested (but deliver the same as above). A request for
-@code{/picture.png} should provide just the same but without any artificial delays.
-
-Now start two instances of your browser (or even use two machines) and see how the second client
-is put on hold while the first waits for his request on the slow file to be fulfilled.
-
-Finally, change the sourcecode to use @code{MHD_USE_THREAD_PER_CONNECTION} when the daemon is
-started and try again.
-
-
-@item
-Did you succeed in implementing the clock exercise yet? This time, let the server save the
-program's start time @code{t} and implement a response simulating a countdown that reaches 0 at
-@code{t+60}. Returning a message saying on which point the countdown is, the response should
-ultimately be to reply "Done" if the program has been running long enough,
-
-A non official, but widely understood, response header line is @code{Refresh: DELAY; url=URL} with
-the uppercase words substituted to tell the client it should request the given resource after
-the given delay again. Improve your program in that the browser (any modern browser should work)
-automatically reconnects and asks for the status again every 5 seconds or so. The URL would have
-to be composed so that it begins with "http://", followed by the @emph{URI} the server is reachable
-from the client's point of view.
-
-Maybe you want also to visualize the countdown as a status bar by creating a
-@code{<table>} consisting of one row and @code{n} columns whose fields contain small images of either
-a red or a green light.
-
-@end itemize
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/tlsauthentication.inc b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/tlsauthentication.inc
deleted file mode 100644
index 37b45b8e3d..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/chapters/tlsauthentication.inc
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,130 +0,0 @@
-We left the basic authentication chapter with the unsatisfactory conclusion that
-any traffic, including the credentials, could be intercepted by anyone between
-the browser client and the server. Protecting the data while it is sent over
-unsecured lines will be the goal of this chapter.
-
-Since version 0.4, the @emph{MHD} library includes support for encrypting the
-traffic by employing SSL/TSL. If @emph{GNU libmicrohttpd} has been configured to
-support these, encryption and decryption can be applied transparently on the
-data being sent, with only minimal changes to the actual source code of the example.
-
-
-@heading Preparation
-
-First, a private key for the server will be generated. With this key, the server
-will later be able to authenticate itself to the client---preventing anyone else
-from stealing the password by faking its identity. The @emph{OpenSSL} suite, which
-is available on many operating systems, can generate such a key. For the scope of
-this tutorial, we will be content with a 1024 bit key:
-@verbatim
-> openssl genrsa -out server.key 1024
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-In addition to the key, a certificate describing the server in human readable tokens
-is also needed. This certificate will be attested with our aforementioned key. In this way,
-we obtain a self-signed certificate, valid for one year.
-
-@verbatim
-> openssl req -days 365 -out server.pem -new -x509 -key server.key
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-To avoid unnecessary error messages in the browser, the certificate needs to
-have a name that matches the @emph{URI}, for example, "localhost" or the domain.
-If you plan to have a publicly reachable server, you will need to ask a trusted third party,
-called @emph{Certificate Authority}, or @emph{CA}, to attest the certificate for you. This way,
-any visitor can make sure the server's identity is real.
-
-Whether the server's certificate is signed by us or a third party, once it has been accepted
-by the client, both sides will be communicating over encrypted channels. From this point on,
-it is the client's turn to authenticate itself. But this has already been implemented in the basic
-authentication scheme.
-
-
-@heading Changing the source code
-
-We merely have to extend the server program so that it loads the two files into memory,
-
-@verbatim
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
- char *key_pem;
- char *cert_pem;
-
- key_pem = load_file (SERVERKEYFILE);
- cert_pem = load_file (SERVERCERTFILE);
-
- if ((key_pem == NULL) || (cert_pem == NULL))
- {
- printf ("The key/certificate files could not be read.\n");
- return 1;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-and then we point the @emph{MHD} daemon to it upon initalization.
-@verbatim
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY | MHD_USE_SSL, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL,
- MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_KEY, key_pem,
- MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_CERT, cert_pem,
- MHD_OPTION_END);
-
- if (NULL == daemon)
- {
- printf ("%s\n", cert_pem);
-
- free (key_pem);
- free (cert_pem);
-
- return 1;
- }
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-The rest consists of little new besides some additional memory cleanups.
-@verbatim
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
- free (key_pem);
- free (cert_pem);
-
- return 0;
-}
-@end verbatim
-@noindent
-
-
-The rather unexciting file loader can be found in the complete example @code{tlsauthentication.c}.
-
-@heading Remarks
-@itemize @bullet
-@item
-While the standard @emph{HTTP} port is 80, it is 443 for @emph{HTTPS}. The common internet browsers assume
-standard @emph{HTTP} if they are asked to access other ports than these. Therefore, you will have to type
-@code{https://localhost:8888} explicitly when you test the example, or the browser will not know how to
-handle the answer properly.
-
-@item
-The remaining weak point is the question how the server will be trusted initially. Either a @emph{CA} signs the
-certificate or the client obtains the key over secure means. Anyway, the clients have to be aware (or configured)
-that they should not accept certificates of unknown origin.
-
-@item
-The introduced method of certificates makes it mandatory to set an expiration date---making it less feasible to
-hardcode certificates in embedded devices.
-
-@item
-The cryptographic facilities consume memory space and computing time. For this reason, websites usually consists
-both of uncritically @emph{HTTP} parts and secured @emph{HTTPS}.
-
-@end itemize
-
-
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/ecos.texi b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/ecos.texi
deleted file mode 100644
index 4ebe40b959..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/ecos.texi
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,420 +0,0 @@
-@cindex GPL, GNU General Public License
-@cindex eCos, GNU General Public License with eCos Extension
-@center Version 2, June 1991
-
-@display
-Copyright @copyright{} 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-59 Temple Place -- Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
-
-Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
-of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-@end display
-
-
-
-
-@subheading Preamble
-
- The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
-freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
-License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
-software---to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
-General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
-Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
-using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
-the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
-your programs, too.
-
- When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
-price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
-have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
-this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
-if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
-in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
-
- To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
-anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
-These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
-distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
-
- For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
-gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
-you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
-source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
-rights.
-
- We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
-(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
-distribute and/or modify the software.
-
- Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
-that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
-software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
-want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
-that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
-authors' reputations.
-
- Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
-patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
-program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
-program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
-patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
-
- The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
-modification follow.
-
-@iftex
-@subheading TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@center TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
-@end ifinfo
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-This License applies to any program or other work which contains
-a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
-under the terms of this General Public License. The ``Program'', below,
-refers to any such program or work, and a ``work based on the Program''
-means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
-that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
-either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
-language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
-the term ``modification''.) Each licensee is addressed as ``you''.
-
-Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
-covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
-running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
-is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
-Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
-Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
-
-@item
-You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
-source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
-conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
-copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
-notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
-and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
-along with the Program.
-
-You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
-you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
-
-@item
-You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
-of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
-distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
-above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
-
-@enumerate a
-@item
-You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
-stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
-
-@item
-You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
-whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
-part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
-parties under the terms of this License.
-
-@item
-If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
-when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
-interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
-announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
-notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
-a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
-these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
-License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
-does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
-the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
-@end enumerate
-
-These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
-identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
-and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
-themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
-sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
-distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
-on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
-this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
-entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
-
-Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
-your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
-exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
-collective works based on the Program.
-
-In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
-with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
-a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
-the scope of this License.
-
-@item
-You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
-under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
-Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
-
-@enumerate a
-@item
-Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
-source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
-1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
-
-@item
-Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
-years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
-cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
-machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
-distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
-customarily used for software interchange; or,
-
-@item
-Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
-to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
-allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
-received the program in object code or executable form with such
-an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
-@end enumerate
-
-The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
-making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
-code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
-associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
-control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
-special exception, the source code distributed need not include
-anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
-form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
-operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
-itself accompanies the executable.
-
-If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
-access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
-access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
-distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
-compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
-
-@item
-You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
-except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
-otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
-void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
-However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
-this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
-parties remain in full compliance.
-
-@item
-You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
-signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
-distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
-prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
-modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
-Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
-all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
-the Program or works based on it.
-
-@item
-Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
-Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
-original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
-these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
-restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
-You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
-this License.
-
-@item
-If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
-infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
-conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
-otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
-excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
-distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
-License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
-may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
-license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
-all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
-the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
-refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
-
-If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
-any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
-apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
-circumstances.
-
-It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
-patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
-such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
-integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
-implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
-generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
-through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
-system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
-to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
-impose that choice.
-
-This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
-be a consequence of the rest of this License.
-
-@item
-If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
-certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
-original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
-may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
-those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
-countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
-the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
-
-@item
-The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
-of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
-be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
-address new problems or concerns.
-
-Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
-specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and ``any
-later version'', you have the option of following the terms and conditions
-either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
-Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
-this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
-Foundation.
-
-@item
-If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
-programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
-to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
-Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
-make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
-of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
-of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
-
-@iftex
-@heading NO WARRANTY
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@center NO WARRANTY
-@end ifinfo
-
-@item
-BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
-FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
-OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
-PROVIDE THE PROGRAM ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
-OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
-MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
-TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
-PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
-REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
-
-@item
-IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
-WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
-REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
-INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
-OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
-TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
-YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
-PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
-POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
-
-@iftex
-@heading ECOS EXTENSION
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@center ECOS EXTENSION
-@end ifinfo
-
-
-@item
-As a special exception, if other files instantiate templates or use
-macros or inline functions from this file, or you compile this file
-and link it with other works to produce a work based on this file,
-this file does not by itself cause the resulting work to be covered by
-the GNU General Public License. However the source code for this file
-must still be made available in accordance with section (3) of the GNU
-General Public License v2.
-
-This exception does not invalidate any other reasons why a work based
-on this file might be covered by the GNU General Public License.
-
-@end enumerate
-
-
-@iftex
-@heading END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@center END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-@end ifinfo
-
-@page
-@unnumberedsec How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
-
- If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
-possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
-free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
-
- To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
-to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
-convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
-the ``copyright'' line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
-
-@smallexample
-@var{one line to give the program's name and an idea of what it does.}
-Copyright (C) 19@var{yy} @var{name of author}
-
-This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
-modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
-as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2
-of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
-
-This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-GNU General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
-with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
-59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
-@end smallexample
-
-Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
-
-If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
-when it starts in an interactive mode:
-
-@smallexample
-Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) 19@var{yy} @var{name of author}
-Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details
-type `show w'. This is free software, and you are welcome
-to redistribute it under certain conditions; type `show c'
-for details.
-@end smallexample
-
-The hypothetical commands @samp{show w} and @samp{show c} should show
-the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, the
-commands you use may be called something other than @samp{show w} and
-@samp{show c}; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu items---whatever
-suits your program.
-
-You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
-school, if any, to sign a ``copyright disclaimer'' for the program, if
-necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
-
-@smallexample
-@group
-Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright
-interest in the program `Gnomovision'
-(which makes passes at compilers) written
-by James Hacker.
-
-@var{signature of Ty Coon}, 1 April 1989
-Ty Coon, President of Vice
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-
-This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
-proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
-consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
-library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General
-Public License instead of this License.
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/basicauthentication.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/basicauthentication.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 389d8bb7b8..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/basicauthentication.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,182 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-#include <time.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-
-#define REALM "\"Maintenance\""
-#define USER "a legitimate user"
-#define PASSWORD "and his password"
-
-
-char *string_to_base64 (const char *message);
-
-
-int
-ask_for_authentication (struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *realm)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- char *headervalue;
- const char *strbase = "Basic realm=";
-
- response = MHD_create_response_from_data (0, NULL, MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
- if (!response)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- headervalue = malloc (strlen (strbase) + strlen (realm) + 1);
- if (!headervalue)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- strcpy (headervalue, strbase);
- strcat (headervalue, realm);
-
- ret = MHD_add_response_header (response, "WWW-Authenticate", headervalue);
- free (headervalue);
- if (!ret)
- {
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_UNAUTHORIZED, response);
-
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-int
-is_authenticated (struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *username, const char *password)
-{
- const char *headervalue;
- char *expected_b64, *expected;
- const char *strbase = "Basic ";
- int authenticated;
-
- headervalue =
- MHD_lookup_connection_value (connection, MHD_HEADER_KIND,
- "Authorization");
- if (NULL == headervalue)
- return 0;
- if (0 != strncmp (headervalue, strbase, strlen (strbase)))
- return 0;
-
- expected = malloc (strlen (username) + 1 + strlen (password) + 1);
- if (NULL == expected)
- return 0;
-
- strcpy (expected, username);
- strcat (expected, ":");
- strcat (expected, password);
-
- expected_b64 = string_to_base64 (expected);
- if (NULL == expected_b64)
- return 0;
-
- strcpy (expected, strbase);
- authenticated =
- (strcmp (headervalue + strlen (strbase), expected_b64) == 0);
-
- free (expected_b64);
-
- return authenticated;
-}
-
-
-int
-secret_page (struct MHD_Connection *connection)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- const char *page = "<html><body>A secret.</body></html>";
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page), (void *) page, MHD_NO,
- MHD_NO);
- if (!response)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- if (0 != strcmp (method, "GET"))
- return MHD_NO;
- if (NULL == *con_cls)
- {
- *con_cls = connection;
- return MHD_YES;
- }
-
- if (!is_authenticated (connection, USER, PASSWORD))
- return ask_for_authentication (connection, REALM);
-
- return secret_page (connection);
-}
-
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- return 1;
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-char *
-string_to_base64 (const char *message)
-{
- const char *lookup =
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789+/";
- unsigned long l;
- int i;
- char *tmp;
- size_t length = strlen (message);
-
- tmp = malloc (length * 2);
- if (NULL == tmp)
- return tmp;
-
- tmp[0] = 0;
-
- for (i = 0; i < length; i += 3)
- {
- l = (((unsigned long) message[i]) << 16)
- | (((i + 1) < length) ? (((unsigned long) message[i + 1]) << 8) : 0)
- | (((i + 2) < length) ? ((unsigned long) message[i + 2]) : 0);
-
-
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[(l >> 18) & 0x3F], 1);
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[(l >> 12) & 0x3F], 1);
-
- if (i + 1 < length)
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[(l >> 6) & 0x3F], 1);
- if (i + 2 < length)
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[l & 0x3F], 1);
- }
-
- if (length % 3)
- strncat (tmp, "===", 3 - length % 3);
-
- return tmp;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/hellobrowser.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/hellobrowser.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 0f2a676229..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/hellobrowser.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,39 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- const char *page = "<html><body>Hello, browser!</body></html>";
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- int ret;
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page), (void *) page, MHD_NO,
- MHD_NO);
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- return 1;
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/largepost.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/largepost.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 6437f036df..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/largepost.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,227 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-#define POSTBUFFERSIZE 512
-#define MAXCLIENTS 2
-
-#define GET 0
-#define POST 1
-
-static unsigned char nr_of_uploading_clients = 0;
-
-struct connection_info_struct
-{
- int connectiontype;
- struct MHD_PostProcessor *postprocessor;
- FILE *fp;
- const char *answerstring;
- int answercode;
-};
-
-const char *askpage = "<html><body>\n\
- Upload a file, please!<br>\n\
- There are %d clients uploading at the moment.<br>\n\
- <form action=\"/filepost\" method=\"post\" enctype=\"multipart/form-data\">\n\
- <input name=\"file\" type=\"file\">\n\
- <input type=\"submit\" value=\" Send \"></form>\n\
- </body></html>";
-
-const char *busypage =
- "<html><body>This server is busy, please try again later.</body></html>";
-
-const char *completepage =
- "<html><body>The upload has been completed.</body></html>";
-
-const char *errorpage =
- "<html><body>This doesn't seem to be right.</body></html>";
-const char *servererrorpage =
- "<html><body>An internal server error has occured.</body></html>";
-const char *fileexistspage =
- "<html><body>This file already exists.</body></html>";
-
-
-int
-send_page (struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *page,
- int status_code)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
-
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page), (void *) page, MHD_NO,
- MHD_YES);
- if (!response)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, status_code, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-
-int
-iterate_post (void *coninfo_cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key,
- const char *filename, const char *content_type,
- const char *transfer_encoding, const char *data, uint64_t off,
- size_t size)
-{
- FILE *fp;
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info =
- (struct connection_info_struct *) coninfo_cls;
-
- con_info->answerstring = servererrorpage;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_INTERNAL_SERVER_ERROR;
-
- if (0 != strcmp (key, "file"))
- return MHD_NO;
-
- if (!con_info->fp)
- {
- if (NULL != (fp = fopen (filename, "rb")))
- {
- fclose (fp);
- con_info->answerstring = fileexistspage;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_FORBIDDEN;
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- con_info->fp = fopen (filename, "ab");
- if (!con_info->fp)
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- if (size > 0)
- {
- if (!fwrite (data, size, sizeof (char), con_info->fp))
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- con_info->answerstring = completepage;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_OK;
-
- return MHD_YES;
-}
-
-void
-request_completed (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- void **con_cls, enum MHD_RequestTerminationCode toe)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info =
- (struct connection_info_struct *) *con_cls;
-
- if (NULL == con_info)
- return;
-
- if (con_info->connectiontype == POST)
- {
- if (NULL != con_info->postprocessor)
- {
- MHD_destroy_post_processor (con_info->postprocessor);
- nr_of_uploading_clients--;
- }
-
- if (con_info->fp)
- fclose (con_info->fp);
- }
-
- free (con_info);
- *con_cls = NULL;
-}
-
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- if (NULL == *con_cls)
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info;
-
- if (nr_of_uploading_clients >= MAXCLIENTS)
- return send_page (connection, busypage, MHD_HTTP_SERVICE_UNAVAILABLE);
-
- con_info = malloc (sizeof (struct connection_info_struct));
- if (NULL == con_info)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- con_info->fp = NULL;
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- con_info->postprocessor =
- MHD_create_post_processor (connection, POSTBUFFERSIZE,
- iterate_post, (void *) con_info);
-
- if (NULL == con_info->postprocessor)
- {
- free (con_info);
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- nr_of_uploading_clients++;
-
- con_info->connectiontype = POST;
- con_info->answercode = MHD_HTTP_OK;
- con_info->answerstring = completepage;
- }
- else
- con_info->connectiontype = GET;
-
- *con_cls = (void *) con_info;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "GET"))
- {
- int ret;
- char buffer[1024] = { 0 };
-
- sprintf (buffer, askpage, nr_of_uploading_clients);
- return send_page (connection, buffer, MHD_HTTP_OK);
- }
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = *con_cls;
-
- if (0 != *upload_data_size)
- {
- MHD_post_process (con_info->postprocessor, upload_data,
- *upload_data_size);
- *upload_data_size = 0;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
- else
- return send_page (connection, con_info->answerstring,
- con_info->answercode);
- }
-
- return send_page (connection, errorpage, MHD_HTTP_BAD_REQUEST);
-}
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL,
- MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED, request_completed,
- NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- return 1;
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
-
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/logging.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/logging.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 1bb2b054d9..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/logging.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,43 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-
-
-int
-print_out_key (void *cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key,
- const char *value)
-{
- printf ("%s = %s\n", key, value);
- return MHD_YES;
-}
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- printf ("New request %s for %s using version %s\n", method, url, version);
-
- MHD_get_connection_values (connection, MHD_HEADER_KIND, print_out_key,
- NULL);
-
- return MHD_NO;
-}
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- return 1;
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/responseheaders.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/responseheaders.c
deleted file mode 100644
index c83b4480ba..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/responseheaders.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,116 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-#include <time.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-#define FILENAME "picture.png"
-#define MIMETYPE "image/png"
-
-
-long
-get_file_size (const char *filename)
-{
- FILE *fp;
-
- fp = fopen (filename, "rb");
- if (fp)
- {
- long size;
-
- if ((0 != fseek (fp, 0, SEEK_END)) || (-1 == (size = ftell (fp))))
- size = 0;
-
- fclose (fp);
-
- return size;
- }
- else
- return 0;
-}
-
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- unsigned char *buffer = NULL;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- long size;
- FILE *fp;
- int ret = 0;
-
- if (0 != strcmp (method, "GET"))
- return MHD_NO;
-
- size = get_file_size (FILENAME);
- if (size != 0)
- {
- fp = fopen (FILENAME, "rb");
- if (fp)
- {
- buffer = malloc (size);
-
- if (buffer)
- if (size == fread (buffer, 1, size, fp))
- ret = 1;
-
- fclose (fp);
- }
- }
-
- if (!ret)
- {
- const char *errorstr =
- "<html><body>An internal server error has occured!\
- </body></html>";
-
- if (buffer)
- free (buffer);
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (errorstr), (void *) errorstr,
- MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
-
- if (response)
- {
- ret =
- MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_INTERNAL_SERVER_ERROR,
- response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
- else
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (size, (void *) buffer, MHD_YES, MHD_NO);
-
- MHD_add_response_header (response, "Content-Type", MIMETYPE);
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- return 1;
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
-
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/simplepost.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/simplepost.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 83c2f3cd5f..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/simplepost.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,186 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-#define POSTBUFFERSIZE 512
-#define MAXNAMESIZE 20
-#define MAXANSWERSIZE 512
-
-#define GET 0
-#define POST 1
-
-struct connection_info_struct
-{
- int connectiontype;
- char *answerstring;
- struct MHD_PostProcessor *postprocessor;
-};
-
-const char *askpage = "<html><body>\
- What's your name, Sir?<br>\
- <form action=\"/namepost\" method=\"post\">\
- <input name=\"name\" type=\"text\"\
- <input type=\"submit\" value=\" Send \"></form>\
- </body></html>";
-
-const char *greatingpage =
- "<html><body><h1>Welcome, %s!</center></h1></body></html>";
-
-const char *errorpage =
- "<html><body>This doesn't seem to be right.</body></html>";
-
-
-int
-send_page (struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *page)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
-
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page), (void *) page, MHD_NO,
- MHD_NO);
- if (!response)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-
-int
-iterate_post (void *coninfo_cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key,
- const char *filename, const char *content_type,
- const char *transfer_encoding, const char *data, uint64_t off,
- size_t size)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info =
- (struct connection_info_struct *) coninfo_cls;
-
-
- if (0 == strcmp (key, "name"))
- {
- if ((size > 0) && (size <= MAXNAMESIZE))
- {
- char *answerstring;
- answerstring = malloc (MAXANSWERSIZE);
- if (!answerstring)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- snprintf (answerstring, MAXANSWERSIZE, greatingpage, data);
- con_info->answerstring = answerstring;
- }
- else
- con_info->answerstring = NULL;
-
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- return MHD_YES;
-}
-
-void
-request_completed (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- void **con_cls, enum MHD_RequestTerminationCode toe)
-{
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info =
- (struct connection_info_struct *) *con_cls;
-
-
- if (NULL == con_info)
- return;
-
- if (con_info->connectiontype == POST)
- {
- MHD_destroy_post_processor (con_info->postprocessor);
- if (con_info->answerstring)
- free (con_info->answerstring);
- }
-
- free (con_info);
- *con_cls = NULL;
-}
-
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- if (NULL == *con_cls)
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info;
-
- con_info = malloc (sizeof (struct connection_info_struct));
- if (NULL == con_info)
- return MHD_NO;
- con_info->answerstring = NULL;
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- con_info->postprocessor =
- MHD_create_post_processor (connection, POSTBUFFERSIZE,
- iterate_post, (void *) con_info);
-
- if (NULL == con_info->postprocessor)
- {
- free (con_info);
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- con_info->connectiontype = POST;
- }
- else
- con_info->connectiontype = GET;
-
- *con_cls = (void *) con_info;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "GET"))
- {
- return send_page (connection, askpage);
- }
-
- if (0 == strcmp (method, "POST"))
- {
- struct connection_info_struct *con_info = *con_cls;
-
- if (*upload_data_size != 0)
- {
- MHD_post_process (con_info->postprocessor, upload_data,
- *upload_data_size);
- *upload_data_size = 0;
-
- return MHD_YES;
- }
- else if (NULL != con_info->answerstring)
- return send_page (connection, con_info->answerstring);
- }
-
- return send_page (connection, errorpage);
-}
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
-
-
- daemon = MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY, PORT, NULL, NULL,
- &answer_to_connection, NULL,
- MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED, request_completed,
- NULL, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- return 1;
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
-
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/tlsauthentication.c b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/tlsauthentication.c
deleted file mode 100644
index 685e5aea67..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/examples/tlsauthentication.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,258 +0,0 @@
-#include <platform.h>
-#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-#define PORT 8888
-
-#define REALM "\"Maintenance\""
-#define USER "a legitimate user"
-#define PASSWORD "and his password"
-
-#define SERVERKEYFILE "server.key"
-#define SERVERCERTFILE "server.pem"
-
-
-char *
-string_to_base64 (const char *message)
-{
- const char *lookup =
- "ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789+/";
- unsigned long l;
- int i;
- char *tmp;
- size_t length = strlen (message);
-
- tmp = malloc (length * 2);
- if (NULL == tmp)
- return tmp;
-
- tmp[0] = 0;
-
- for (i = 0; i < length; i += 3)
- {
- l = (((unsigned long) message[i]) << 16)
- | (((i + 1) < length) ? (((unsigned long) message[i + 1]) << 8) : 0)
- | (((i + 2) < length) ? ((unsigned long) message[i + 2]) : 0);
-
-
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[(l >> 18) & 0x3F], 1);
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[(l >> 12) & 0x3F], 1);
-
- if (i + 1 < length)
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[(l >> 6) & 0x3F], 1);
- if (i + 2 < length)
- strncat (tmp, &lookup[l & 0x3F], 1);
- }
-
- if (length % 3)
- strncat (tmp, "===", 3 - length % 3);
-
- return tmp;
-}
-
-
-long
-get_file_size (const char *filename)
-{
- FILE *fp;
-
- fp = fopen (filename, "rb");
- if (fp)
- {
- long size;
-
- if ((0 != fseek (fp, 0, SEEK_END)) || (-1 == (size = ftell (fp))))
- size = 0;
-
- fclose (fp);
-
- return size;
- }
- else
- return 0;
-}
-
-char *
-load_file (const char *filename)
-{
- FILE *fp;
- char *buffer;
- long size;
-
- size = get_file_size (filename);
- if (size == 0)
- return NULL;
-
- fp = fopen (filename, "rb");
- if (!fp)
- return NULL;
-
- buffer = malloc (size);
- if (!buffer)
- {
- fclose (fp);
- return NULL;
- }
-
- if (size != fread (buffer, 1, size, fp))
- {
- free (buffer);
- buffer = NULL;
- }
-
- fclose (fp);
- return buffer;
-}
-
-int
-ask_for_authentication (struct MHD_Connection *connection, const char *realm)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- char *headervalue;
- const char *strbase = "Basic realm=";
-
- response = MHD_create_response_from_data (0, NULL, MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
- if (!response)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- headervalue = malloc (strlen (strbase) + strlen (realm) + 1);
- if (!headervalue)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- strcpy (headervalue, strbase);
- strcat (headervalue, realm);
-
- ret = MHD_add_response_header (response, "WWW-Authenticate", headervalue);
- free (headervalue);
- if (!ret)
- {
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
- return MHD_NO;
- }
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_UNAUTHORIZED, response);
-
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-int
-is_authenticated (struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *username, const char *password)
-{
- const char *headervalue;
- char *expected_b64, *expected;
- const char *strbase = "Basic ";
- int authenticated;
-
- headervalue =
- MHD_lookup_connection_value (connection, MHD_HEADER_KIND,
- "Authorization");
- if (NULL == headervalue)
- return 0;
- if (0 != strncmp (headervalue, strbase, strlen (strbase)))
- return 0;
-
- expected = malloc (strlen (username) + 1 + strlen (password) + 1);
- if (NULL == expected)
- return 0;
-
- strcpy (expected, username);
- strcat (expected, ":");
- strcat (expected, password);
-
- expected_b64 = string_to_base64 (expected);
- if (NULL == expected_b64)
- return 0;
-
- strcpy (expected, strbase);
- authenticated =
- (strcmp (headervalue + strlen (strbase), expected_b64) == 0);
-
- free (expected_b64);
-
- return authenticated;
-}
-
-
-int
-secret_page (struct MHD_Connection *connection)
-{
- int ret;
- struct MHD_Response *response;
- const char *page = "<html><body>A secret.</body></html>";
-
- response =
- MHD_create_response_from_data (strlen (page), (void *) page, MHD_NO,
- MHD_NO);
- if (!response)
- return MHD_NO;
-
- ret = MHD_queue_response (connection, MHD_HTTP_OK, response);
- MHD_destroy_response (response);
-
- return ret;
-}
-
-
-int
-answer_to_connection (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection *connection,
- const char *url, const char *method,
- const char *version, const char *upload_data,
- size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-{
- if (0 != strcmp (method, "GET"))
- return MHD_NO;
- if (NULL == *con_cls)
- {
- *con_cls = connection;
- return MHD_YES;
- }
-
- if (!is_authenticated (connection, USER, PASSWORD))
- return ask_for_authentication (connection, REALM);
-
- return secret_page (connection);
-}
-
-
-int
-main ()
-{
- struct MHD_Daemon *daemon;
- char *key_pem;
- char *cert_pem;
-
- key_pem = load_file (SERVERKEYFILE);
- cert_pem = load_file (SERVERCERTFILE);
-
- if ((key_pem == NULL) || (cert_pem == NULL))
- {
- printf ("The key/certificate files could not be read.\n");
- return 1;
- }
-
- daemon =
- MHD_start_daemon (MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY | MHD_USE_SSL, PORT, NULL,
- NULL, &answer_to_connection, NULL,
- MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_KEY, key_pem,
- MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_CERT, cert_pem, MHD_OPTION_END);
- if (NULL == daemon)
- {
- printf ("%s\n", cert_pem);
-
- free (key_pem);
- free (cert_pem);
-
- return 1;
- }
-
- getchar ();
-
- MHD_stop_daemon (daemon);
- free (key_pem);
- free (cert_pem);
-
- return 0;
-}
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/fdl-1.3.texi b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/fdl-1.3.texi
deleted file mode 100644
index 8805f1a47d..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/fdl-1.3.texi
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,506 +0,0 @@
-@c The GNU Free Documentation License.
-@center Version 1.3, 3 November 2008
-
-@c This file is intended to be included within another document,
-@c hence no sectioning command or @node.
-
-@display
-Copyright @copyright{} 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-@uref{http://fsf.org/}
-
-Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
-of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-@end display
-
-@enumerate 0
-@item
-PREAMBLE
-
-The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
-functional and useful document @dfn{free} in the sense of freedom: to
-assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
-with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
-Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
-to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
-for modifications made by others.
-
-This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
-works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
-complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
-license designed for free software.
-
-We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
-software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
-program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
-software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
-it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
-whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
-principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
-
-@item
-APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
-
-This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
-contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
-distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
-world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
-work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
-refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
-licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
-copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
-under copyright law.
-
-A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
-Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
-modifications and/or translated into another language.
-
-A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section
-of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
-publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall
-subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall
-directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in
-part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain
-any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
-connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
-commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
-them.
-
-The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
-are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
-that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
-section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
-allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
-Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
-Sections then there are none.
-
-The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
-as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
-the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
-be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
-
-A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
-represented in a format whose specification is available to the
-general public, that is suitable for revising the document
-straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
-pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
-drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
-for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
-to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
-format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
-or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
-An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
-of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque''.
-
-Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
-@sc{ascii} without markup, Texinfo input format, La@TeX{} input
-format, @acronym{SGML} or @acronym{XML} using a publicly available
-@acronym{DTD}, and standard-conforming simple @acronym{HTML},
-PostScript or @acronym{PDF} designed for human modification. Examples
-of transparent image formats include @acronym{PNG}, @acronym{XCF} and
-@acronym{JPG}. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be
-read and edited only by proprietary word processors, @acronym{SGML} or
-@acronym{XML} for which the @acronym{DTD} and/or processing tools are
-not generally available, and the machine-generated @acronym{HTML},
-PostScript or @acronym{PDF} produced by some word processors for
-output purposes only.
-
-The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
-plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
-this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
-formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
-the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
-preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
-
-The ``publisher'' means any person or entity that distributes copies
-of the Document to the public.
-
-A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
-title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
-text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
-specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
-``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title''
-of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
-section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
-
-The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
-states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
-Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
-License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
-implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
-no effect on the meaning of this License.
-
-@item
-VERBATIM COPYING
-
-You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
-commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
-copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
-to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
-conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
-technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
-copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
-compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
-number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
-
-You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
-you may publicly display copies.
-
-@item
-COPYING IN QUANTITY
-
-If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
-printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
-Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
-copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
-Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
-the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
-you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
-the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
-visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
-Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
-the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
-as verbatim copying in other respects.
-
-If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
-legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
-reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
-pages.
-
-If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
-more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
-copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
-a computer-network location from which the general network-using
-public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
-a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
-If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
-when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
-that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
-location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
-Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
-edition to the public.
-
-It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
-Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
-them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
-
-@item
-MODIFICATIONS
-
-You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
-the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release
-the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
-Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
-and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
-of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
-
-@enumerate A
-@item
-Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
-from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
-(which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
-of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
-if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
-
-@item
-List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
-responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
-Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
-Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
-unless they release you from this requirement.
-
-@item
-State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
-Modified Version, as the publisher.
-
-@item
-Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
-
-@item
-Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
-adjacent to the other copyright notices.
-
-@item
-Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
-giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
-terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
-
-@item
-Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
-and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
-
-@item
-Include an unaltered copy of this License.
-
-@item
-Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
-to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
-publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
-there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
-stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
-given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
-Version as stated in the previous sentence.
-
-@item
-Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
-public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
-the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
-it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
-You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
-least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
-publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
-
-@item
-For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'', Preserve
-the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the
-substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or
-dedications given therein.
-
-@item
-Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
-unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
-or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
-
-@item
-Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements''. Such a section
-may not be included in the Modified Version.
-
-@item
-Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements'' or
-to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
-
-@item
-Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
-@end enumerate
-
-If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
-appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
-copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
-of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
-list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
-These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
-
-You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
-nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
-parties---for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
-been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
-standard.
-
-You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
-passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
-of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
-Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
-through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
-includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
-by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
-you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
-permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
-
-The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
-give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
-imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
-
-@item
-COMBINING DOCUMENTS
-
-You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
-License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified
-versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
-Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
-list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
-license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
-
-The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
-multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
-copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
-different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
-adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
-author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
-Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
-Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
-
-In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
-in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
-``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
-and any sections Entitled ``Dedications''. You must delete all
-sections Entitled ``Endorsements.''
-
-@item
-COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
-
-You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
-released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
-License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
-the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
-verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
-
-You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
-it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
-License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
-other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
-
-@item
-AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
-
-A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
-and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
-distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
-resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
-of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
-When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
-apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
-derivative works of the Document.
-
-If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these
-copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of
-the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
-covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
-electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
-Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
-aggregate.
-
-@item
-TRANSLATION
-
-Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
-distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
-Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
-permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
-translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
-original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
-translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
-Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
-the original English version of this License and the original versions
-of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
-the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
-or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
-
-If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
-``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement (section 4) to Preserve
-its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual
-title.
-
-@item
-TERMINATION
-
-You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document
-except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
-otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and
-will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
-
-However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license
-from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally,
-unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally
-terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder
-fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to
-60 days after the cessation.
-
-Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
-reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
-violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
-received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
-copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
-your receipt of the notice.
-
-Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
-licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
-this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
-reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does
-not give you any rights to use it.
-
-@item
-FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
-
-The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
-of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
-versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
-differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
-@uref{http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/}.
-
-Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
-If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
-License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
-following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
-of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
-Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
-number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
-as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document
-specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of this
-License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a
-version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the
-Document.
-
-@item
-RELICENSING
-
-``Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site'' (or ``MMC Site'') means any
-World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also
-provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A
-public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A
-``Massive Multiauthor Collaboration'' (or ``MMC'') contained in the
-site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC
-site.
-
-``CC-BY-SA'' means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0
-license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit
-corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco,
-California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license
-published by that same organization.
-
-``Incorporate'' means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or
-in part, as part of another Document.
-
-An MMC is ``eligible for relicensing'' if it is licensed under this
-License, and if all works that were first published under this License
-somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently incorporated in whole
-or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections,
-and (2) were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008.
-
-The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site
-under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009,
-provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
-
-@end enumerate
-
-@page
-@heading ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
-
-To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
-the License in the document and put the following copyright and
-license notices just after the title page:
-
-@smallexample
-@group
- Copyright (C) @var{year} @var{your name}.
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
- under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
- or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
- with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
- Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
- Free Documentation License''.
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-
-If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
-replace the ``with@dots{}Texts.'' line with this:
-
-@smallexample
-@group
- with the Invariant Sections being @var{list their titles}, with
- the Front-Cover Texts being @var{list}, and with the Back-Cover Texts
- being @var{list}.
-@end group
-@end smallexample
-
-If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
-combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
-situation.
-
-If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
-recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
-free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
-to permit their use in free software.
-
-@c Local Variables:
-@c ispell-local-pdict: "ispell-dict"
-@c End:
-
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/lgpl.texi b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/lgpl.texi
deleted file mode 100644
index 260c0ce089..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/lgpl.texi
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,561 +0,0 @@
-@c The GNU Lesser General Public License.
-@center Version 2.1, February 1999
-
-@c This file is intended to be included within another document,
-@c hence no sectioning command or @node.
-
-@display
-Copyright @copyright{} 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA
-
-Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
-of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-
-[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts
-as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the
-version number 2.1.]
-@end display
-
-@subheading Preamble
-
- The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
-freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
-Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change
-free software---to make sure the software is free for all its users.
-
- This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some
-specially designated software---typically libraries---of the Free
-Software Foundation and other authors who decide to use it. You can use
-it too, but we suggest you first think carefully about whether this
-license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy to
-use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
-
- When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use,
-not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that
-you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge
-for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get
-it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of it
-in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do these
-things.
-
- To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
-distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender these
-rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for
-you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
-
- For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis
-or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave
-you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source
-code. If you link other code with the library, you must provide
-complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them
-with the library after making changes to the library and recompiling
-it. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
-
- We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the
-library, and (2) we offer you this license, which gives you legal
-permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library.
-
- To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that
-there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the library is
-modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should know
-that what they have is not the original version, so that the original
-author's reputation will not be affected by problems that might be
-introduced by others.
-
- Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of
-any free program. We wish to make sure that a company cannot
-effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a
-restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist that
-any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be
-consistent with the full freedom of use specified in this license.
-
- Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the
-ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser
-General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries, and
-is quite different from the ordinary General Public License. We use
-this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those
-libraries into non-free programs.
-
- When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using
-a shared library, the combination of the two is legally speaking a
-combined work, a derivative of the original library. The ordinary
-General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the
-entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General
-Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with
-the library.
-
- We call this license the @dfn{Lesser} General Public License because it
-does @emph{Less} to protect the user's freedom than the ordinary General
-Public License. It also provides other free software developers Less
-of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These disadvantages
-are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many
-libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain
-special circumstances.
-
- For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to
-encourage the widest possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes
-a de-facto standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must be
-allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a free
-library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this
-case, there is little to gain by limiting the free library to free
-software only, so we use the Lesser General Public License.
-
- In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free
-programs enables a greater number of people to use a large body of
-free software. For example, permission to use the GNU C Library in
-non-free programs enables many more people to use the whole GNU
-operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating
-system.
-
- Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the
-users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is
-linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run
-that program using a modified version of the Library.
-
- The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
-modification follow. Pay close attention to the difference between a
-``work based on the library'' and a ``work that uses the library''. The
-former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter must
-be combined with the library in order to run.
-
-@subheading TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
-
-@enumerate 0
-@item
-This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program
-which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other
-authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of this
-Lesser General Public License (also called ``this License''). Each
-licensee is addressed as ``you''.
-
- A ``library'' means a collection of software functions and/or data
-prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs
-(which use some of those functions and data) to form executables.
-
- The ``Library'', below, refers to any such software library or work
-which has been distributed under these terms. A ``work based on the
-Library'' means either the Library or any derivative work under
-copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a
-portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated
-straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is
-included without limitation in the term ``modification''.)
-
- ``Source code'' for a work means the preferred form of the work for
-making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means
-all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated
-interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation
-and installation of the library.
-
- Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
-covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
-running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from
-such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based
-on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for
-writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does
-and what the program that uses the Library does.
-
-@item
-You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library's
-complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that
-you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an
-appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact
-all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any
-warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the
-Library.
-
- You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy,
-and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a
-fee.
-
-@item
-You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion
-of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and
-distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
-above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
-
-@enumerate a
-@item
-The modified work must itself be a software library.
-
-@item
-You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices
-stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
-
-@item
-You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no
-charge to all third parties under the terms of this License.
-
-@item
-If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a
-table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses
-the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility
-is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that,
-in the event an application does not supply such function or
-table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of
-its purpose remains meaningful.
-
-(For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has
-a purpose that is entirely well-defined independent of the
-application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any
-application-supplied function or table used by this function must
-be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square
-root function must still compute square roots.)
-@end enumerate
-
-These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
-identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library,
-and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
-themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
-sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
-distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
-on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
-this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
-entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote
-it.
-
-Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
-your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
-exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
-collective works based on the Library.
-
-In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library
-with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of
-a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
-the scope of this License.
-
-@item
-You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public
-License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do
-this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so
-that they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2,
-instead of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the
-ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify
-that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in
-these notices.
-
- Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for
-that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all
-subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy.
-
- This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of
-the Library into a program that is not a library.
-
-@item
-You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or
-derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form
-under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany
-it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which
-must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a
-medium customarily used for software interchange.
-
- If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy
-from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the
-source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to
-distribute the source code, even though third parties are not
-compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
-
-@item
-A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the
-Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or
-linked with it, is called a ``work that uses the Library''. Such a
-work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and
-therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
-
- However, linking a ``work that uses the Library'' with the Library
-creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it
-contains portions of the Library), rather than a ``work that uses the
-library''. The executable is therefore covered by this License.
-Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables.
-
- When a ``work that uses the Library'' uses material from a header file
-that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a
-derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not.
-Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be
-linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The
-threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law.
-
- If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data
-structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline
-functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object
-file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative
-work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the
-Library will still fall under Section 6.)
-
- Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may
-distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6.
-Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6,
-whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
-
-@item
-As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or
-link a ``work that uses the Library'' with the Library to produce a
-work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work
-under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit
-modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse
-engineering for debugging such modifications.
-
- You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the
-Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by
-this License. You must supply a copy of this License. If the work
-during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the
-copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference
-directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one
-of these things:
-
-@enumerate a
-@item
-Accompany the work with the complete corresponding
-machine-readable source code for the Library including whatever
-changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under
-Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked
-with the Library, with the complete machine-readable ``work that
-uses the Library'', as object code and/or source code, so that the
-user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified
-executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood
-that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the
-Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application
-to use the modified definitions.)
-
-@item
-Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A
-suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the
-library already present on the user's computer system, rather than
-copying library functions into the executable, and (2) will operate
-properly with a modified version of the library, if the user installs
-one, as long as the modified version is interface-compatible with the
-version that the work was made with.
-
-@item
-Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at
-least three years, to give the same user the materials
-specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more
-than the cost of performing this distribution.
-
-@item
-If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy
-from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above
-specified materials from the same place.
-
-@item
-Verify that the user has already received a copy of these
-materials or that you have already sent this user a copy.
-@end enumerate
-
- For an executable, the required form of the ``work that uses the
-Library'' must include any data and utility programs needed for
-reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception,
-the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is
-normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major
-components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on
-which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the
-executable.
-
- It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license
-restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally
-accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot
-use both them and the Library together in an executable that you
-distribute.
-
-@item
-You may place library facilities that are a work based on the
-Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library
-facilities not covered by this License, and distribute such a combined
-library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on
-the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise
-permitted, and provided that you do these two things:
-
-@enumerate a
-@item
-Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work
-based on the Library, uncombined with any other library
-facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the
-Sections above.
-
-@item
-Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact
-that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining
-where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
-@end enumerate
-
-@item
-You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute
-the Library except as expressly provided under this License. Any
-attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
-distribute the Library is void, and will automatically terminate your
-rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies,
-or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses
-terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
-
-@item
-You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
-signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
-distribute the Library or its derivative works. These actions are
-prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
-modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on the
-Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
-all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
-the Library or works based on it.
-
-@item
-Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the
-Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
-original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library
-subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
-restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
-You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with
-this License.
-
-@item
-If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
-infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
-conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
-otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
-excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
-distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
-License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
-may not distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent
-license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by
-all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
-the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
-refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.
-
-If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any
-particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply,
-and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances.
-
-It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
-patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
-such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
-integrity of the free software distribution system which is
-implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
-generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
-through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
-system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
-to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
-impose that choice.
-
-This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
-be a consequence of the rest of this License.
-
-@item
-If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in
-certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
-original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add
-an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries,
-so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus
-excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if
-written in the body of this License.
-
-@item
-The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new
-versions of the Lesser General Public License from time to time.
-Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version,
-but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
-
-Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library
-specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and
-``any later version'', you have the option of following the terms and
-conditions either of that version or of any later version published by
-the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
-license version number, you may choose any version ever published by
-the Free Software Foundation.
-
-@item
-If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free
-programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these,
-write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is
-copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free
-Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our
-decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status
-of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing
-and reuse of software generally.
-
-@iftex
-@heading NO WARRANTY
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@center NO WARRANTY
-
-@end ifinfo
-
-@item
-BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
-WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
-EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR
-OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY ``AS IS'' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
-KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
-IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
-PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
-LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
-THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
-
-@item
-IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
-WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY
-AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU
-FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
-CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
-LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
-RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A
-FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF
-SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGES.
-@end enumerate
-
-@iftex
-@heading END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-@end iftex
-@ifinfo
-@center END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-
-@end ifinfo
-
-@page
-@subheading How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
-
- If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest
-possible use to the public, we recommend making it free software that
-everyone can redistribute and change. You can do so by permitting
-redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the
-ordinary General Public License).
-
- To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is
-safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
-convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the
-``copyright'' line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
-
-@smallexample
-@var{one line to give the library's name and an idea of what it does.}
-Copyright (C) @var{year} @var{name of author}
-
-This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
-under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by
-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the License, or (at
-your option) any later version.
-
-This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
-WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
-Lesser General Public License for more details.
-
-You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
-License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software
-Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301,
-USA.
-@end smallexample
-
-Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
-
-You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
-school, if any, to sign a ``copyright disclaimer'' for the library, if
-necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
-
-@smallexample
-Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the library
-`Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
-
-@var{signature of Ty Coon}, 1 April 1990
-Ty Coon, President of Vice
-@end smallexample
-
-That's all there is to it!
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/libmicrohttpd.3 b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/libmicrohttpd.3
deleted file mode 100644
index e172e835e9..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/libmicrohttpd.3
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,40 +0,0 @@
-.TH LIBMICROHTTPD "3" "28 Oct 2009 "libmicrohttpd"
-.SH "NAME"
-GNU libmicrohttpd \- library for embedding HTTP servers
-.SH "SYNOPSIS"
-
-\fB#include <sys/types.h>
-\fB#include <sys/select.h>
-\fB#include <sys/socket.h>
-\fB#include <microhttpd.h>
-
-.SH "DESCRIPTION"
-.P
-GNU libmicrohttpd (short MHD) allows applications to easily integrate the functionality of a simple HTTP server. MHD is a GNU package.
-.P
-The details of the API are described in comments in the header file, a detailed reference documentation and in brief on the MHD webpage.
-.P
-.SH "SEE ALSO"
-\fBcurl\fP(1), \fBlibcurl\fP(3)
-
-.SH "LEGAL NOTICE"
-libmicrohttpd is released under both the LGPL Version 2 or higher and
-the GNU GPL with eCos extension. For details on both licenses please
-read the respective appendix in the manual.
-
-.SH "FILES"
-.TP
-microhttpd.h
-libmicrohttpd include file
-.TP
-libmicrohttpd.so
-libmicrohttpd library
-
-.SH "REPORTING BUGS"
-Report bugs by using mantis <https://gnunet.org/mantis/>.
-
-.SH "AUTHORS"
-GNU libmicrohttpd was originally designed by Christian Grothoff <christian@grothoff.org> and Chris GauthierDickey <chrisg@cs.du.edu>. The original implementation was done by Daniel Pittman <depittman@gmail.com> and Christian Grothoff. SSL/TLS support was added by Sagie Amir using code from gnutls. See the AUTHORS file in the distribution for a more detailed list of contributors.
-
-.SH "AVAILABILITY"
-You can obtain the latest version from http://www.gnu.org/software/libmicrohttpd/.
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/mdate-sh b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/mdate-sh
deleted file mode 100755
index e631b2219a..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/mdate-sh
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,205 +0,0 @@
-#!/bin/sh
-# Get modification time of a file or directory and pretty-print it.
-
-scriptversion=2009-04-28.21; # UTC
-
-# Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2009 Free
-# Software Foundation, Inc.
-# written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, June 1995
-#
-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
-# any later version.
-#
-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
-# GNU General Public License for more details.
-#
-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-
-# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
-# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
-# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
-# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
-
-# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
-# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
-# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
-
-case $1 in
- '')
- echo "$0: No file. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
- exit 1;
- ;;
- -h | --h*)
- cat <<\EOF
-Usage: mdate-sh [--help] [--version] FILE
-
-Pretty-print the modification time of FILE.
-
-Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
-EOF
- exit $?
- ;;
- -v | --v*)
- echo "mdate-sh $scriptversion"
- exit $?
- ;;
-esac
-
-# Prevent date giving response in another language.
-LANG=C
-export LANG
-LC_ALL=C
-export LC_ALL
-LC_TIME=C
-export LC_TIME
-
-# GNU ls changes its time format in response to the TIME_STYLE
-# variable. Since we cannot assume `unset' works, revert this
-# variable to its documented default.
-if test "${TIME_STYLE+set}" = set; then
- TIME_STYLE=posix-long-iso
- export TIME_STYLE
-fi
-
-save_arg1=$1
-
-# Find out how to get the extended ls output of a file or directory.
-if ls -L /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then
- ls_command='ls -L -l -d'
-else
- ls_command='ls -l -d'
-fi
-# Avoid user/group names that might have spaces, when possible.
-if ls -n /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then
- ls_command="$ls_command -n"
-fi
-
-# A `ls -l' line looks as follows on OS/2.
-# drwxrwx--- 0 Aug 11 2001 foo
-# This differs from Unix, which adds ownership information.
-# drwxrwx--- 2 root root 4096 Aug 11 2001 foo
-#
-# To find the date, we split the line on spaces and iterate on words
-# until we find a month. This cannot work with files whose owner is a
-# user named `Jan', or `Feb', etc. However, it's unlikely that `/'
-# will be owned by a user whose name is a month. So we first look at
-# the extended ls output of the root directory to decide how many
-# words should be skipped to get the date.
-
-# On HPUX /bin/sh, "set" interprets "-rw-r--r--" as options, so the "x" below.
-set x`$ls_command /`
-
-# Find which argument is the month.
-month=
-command=
-until test $month
-do
- shift
- # Add another shift to the command.
- command="$command shift;"
- case $1 in
- Jan) month=January; nummonth=1;;
- Feb) month=February; nummonth=2;;
- Mar) month=March; nummonth=3;;
- Apr) month=April; nummonth=4;;
- May) month=May; nummonth=5;;
- Jun) month=June; nummonth=6;;
- Jul) month=July; nummonth=7;;
- Aug) month=August; nummonth=8;;
- Sep) month=September; nummonth=9;;
- Oct) month=October; nummonth=10;;
- Nov) month=November; nummonth=11;;
- Dec) month=December; nummonth=12;;
- esac
-done
-
-# Get the extended ls output of the file or directory.
-set dummy x`eval "$ls_command \"\$save_arg1\""`
-
-# Remove all preceding arguments
-eval $command
-
-# Because of the dummy argument above, month is in $2.
-#
-# On a POSIX system, we should have
-#
-# $# = 5
-# $1 = file size
-# $2 = month
-# $3 = day
-# $4 = year or time
-# $5 = filename
-#
-# On Darwin 7.7.0 and 7.6.0, we have
-#
-# $# = 4
-# $1 = day
-# $2 = month
-# $3 = year or time
-# $4 = filename
-
-# Get the month.
-case $2 in
- Jan) month=January; nummonth=1;;
- Feb) month=February; nummonth=2;;
- Mar) month=March; nummonth=3;;
- Apr) month=April; nummonth=4;;
- May) month=May; nummonth=5;;
- Jun) month=June; nummonth=6;;
- Jul) month=July; nummonth=7;;
- Aug) month=August; nummonth=8;;
- Sep) month=September; nummonth=9;;
- Oct) month=October; nummonth=10;;
- Nov) month=November; nummonth=11;;
- Dec) month=December; nummonth=12;;
-esac
-
-case $3 in
- ???*) day=$1;;
- *) day=$3; shift;;
-esac
-
-# Here we have to deal with the problem that the ls output gives either
-# the time of day or the year.
-case $3 in
- *:*) set `date`; eval year=\$$#
- case $2 in
- Jan) nummonthtod=1;;
- Feb) nummonthtod=2;;
- Mar) nummonthtod=3;;
- Apr) nummonthtod=4;;
- May) nummonthtod=5;;
- Jun) nummonthtod=6;;
- Jul) nummonthtod=7;;
- Aug) nummonthtod=8;;
- Sep) nummonthtod=9;;
- Oct) nummonthtod=10;;
- Nov) nummonthtod=11;;
- Dec) nummonthtod=12;;
- esac
- # For the first six month of the year the time notation can also
- # be used for files modified in the last year.
- if (expr $nummonth \> $nummonthtod) > /dev/null;
- then
- year=`expr $year - 1`
- fi;;
- *) year=$3;;
-esac
-
-# The result.
-echo $day $month $year
-
-# Local Variables:
-# mode: shell-script
-# sh-indentation: 2
-# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
-# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
-# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC"
-# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC"
-# End:
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/microhttpd.texi b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/microhttpd.texi
deleted file mode 100644
index b862230b10..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/microhttpd.texi
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,1498 +0,0 @@
-\input texinfo
-@setfilename microhttpd.info
-@include version.texi
-@settitle The GNU libmicrohttpd Reference Manual
-@c Unify some of the indices.
-@c %**end of header
-@copying
-This manual documents GNU libmicrohttpd version @value{VERSION}, last
-updated @value{UPDATED}. It is built upon the documentation in the
-header file @file{microhttpd.h}.
-
-@noindent
-
-Copyright @copyright{} 2007, 2008, 2009 Christian Grothoff
-
-@quotation
-Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
-under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
-or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
-with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
-Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU
-Free Documentation License".
-@end quotation
-@end copying
-
-@dircategory GNU Libraries
-@direntry
-* libmicrohttpd: (microhttpd). Embedded HTTP server library.
-@end direntry
-
-@c
-@c Titlepage
-@c
-@setchapternewpage odd
-@titlepage
-@title The GNU libmicrohttpd Reference Manual
-@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
-@subtitle @value{UPDATED}
-@author Marco Maggi (@email{marco.maggi-ipsu@@poste.it})
-@author Christian Grothoff (@email{christian@@grothoff.org})
-
-@page
-@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-@insertcopying
-@end titlepage
-
-@summarycontents
-@contents
-@page
-
-
-@macro gnu{}
-@acronym{GNU}
-@end macro
-
-@macro gpl{}
-@acronym{LGPL}
-@end macro
-
-@macro http{}
-@acronym{HTTP}
-@end macro
-
-@macro tcp{}
-@acronym{TCP}
-@end macro
-
-@macro api{}
-@acronym{API}
-@end macro
-
-@macro urloc{}
-@acronym{URL}
-@end macro
-
-@macro uri{}
-@acronym{URI}
-@end macro
-
-@macro ascii{}
-@acronym{ASCII}
-@end macro
-
-@c ............................................................
-
-@macro cfunction{arg}
-@code{\arg\()}
-@end macro
-
-@macro mynull{}
-@code{NULL}
-@end macro
-
-@macro mhd{}
-@acronym{MHD}
-@end macro
-
-@c ............................................................
-
-@macro glibcref{NODE, NODE}
-@pxref{\NODE\, \NODE\, \NODE\, libc}
-@end macro
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@ifnottex
-@node Top
-@top The GNU libmicrohttpd Library
-@insertcopying
-@end ifnottex
-
-GNU libmicrohttpd is a GNU package.
-
-@menu
-* microhttpd-intro:: Introduction.
-* microhttpd-const:: Constants.
-* microhttpd-struct:: Structures type definition.
-* microhttpd-cb:: Callback functions definition.
-* microhttpd-init:: Starting and stopping the server.
-* microhttpd-inspect:: Implementing external @code{select}.
-* microhttpd-requests:: Handling requests.
-* microhttpd-responses:: Building responses to requests.
-* microhttpd-post:: Adding a @code{POST} processor.
-* microhttpd-info:: Obtaining status information.
-
-Appendices
-
-* GNU-LGPL:: The GNU Lesser General Public License says how you
- can copy and share almost all of `libmicrohttpd'.
-* GNU GPL with eCos Extension:: The GNU General Public License with eCos extension says how you
- can copy and share some parts of `libmicrohttpd'.
-* GNU-FDL:: The GNU Free Documentation License says how you
- can copy and share the documentation of `libmicrohttpd'.
-
-Indices
-
-* Concept Index:: Index of concepts and programs.
-* Function and Data Index:: Index of functions, variables and data types.
-* Type Index:: Index of data types.
-@end menu
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-intro
-@chapter Introduction
-
-
-@noindent
-All symbols defined in the public @api{} start with @code{MHD_}. @mhd{}
-is a small @http{} daemon library. As such, it does not have any @api{}
-for logging errors (you can only enable or disable logging to stderr).
-Also, it may not support all of the @http{} features directly, where
-applicable, portions of @http{} may have to be handled by clients of the
-library.
-
-The library is supposed to handle everything that it must handle
-(because the @api{} would not allow clients to do this), such as basic
-connection management; however, detailed interpretations of headers ---
-such as range requests --- and @http{} methods are left to clients. The
-library does understand @code{HEAD} and will only send the headers of
-the response and not the body, even if the client supplied a body. The
-library also understands headers that control connection management
-(specifically, @code{Connection: close} and @code{Expect: 100 continue}
-are understood and handled automatically).
-
-@mhd{} understands @code{POST} data and is able to decode certain
-formats (at the moment only @code{application/x-www-form-urlencoded}
-and @code{multipart/form-data}) using the post processor API. The
-data stream of a POST is also provided directly to the main
-application, so unsupported encodings could still be processed, just
-not conveniently by @mhd{}.
-
-The header file defines various constants used by the @http{} protocol.
-This does not mean that @mhd{} actually interprets all of these values.
-The provided constants are exported as a convenience for users of the
-library. @mhd{} does not verify that transmitted @http{} headers are
-part of the standard specification; users of the library are free to
-define their own extensions of the @http{} standard and use those with
-@mhd{}.
-
-All functions are guaranteed to be completely reentrant and
-thread-safe. @mhd{} checks for allocation failures and tries to
-recover gracefully (for example, by closing the connection).
-Additionally, clients can specify resource limits on the overall
-number of connections, number of connections per IP address and memory
-used per connection to avoid resource exhaustion.
-
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-const
-@chapter Constants
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_FLAG
-Options for the @mhd{} daemon.
-
-Note that if neither @code{MHD_USER_THREAD_PER_CONNECTION} nor
-@code{MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY} are used, the client wants control over
-the process and will call the appropriate microhttpd callbacks.
-
-Starting the daemon may also fail if a particular option is not
-implemented or not supported on the target platform (i.e. no support for
-@acronym{SSL}, threads or IPv6). SSL support generally depends on
-options given during @mhd{} compilation. Threaded operations
-(including @code{MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY}) are not supported on
-Symbian.
-
-@table @code
-@item MHD_NO_FLAG
-No options selected.
-
-@item MHD_USE_DEBUG
-@cindex debugging
-Run in debug mode. If this flag is used, the library should print error
-messages and warnings to stderr. Note that @mhd{} also needs to be
-compiled with the configure option @code{--enable-messages} for this
-run-time option to have any effect.
-
-@item MHD_USE_SSL
-Run in https mode (this option may not work with all threading modes yet).
-
-@item MHD_USE_THREAD_PER_CONNECTION
-Run using one thread per connection.
-
-@item MHD_USE_SELECT_INTERNALLY
-Run using an internal thread doing @code{SELECT}.
-
-@item MHD_USE_IPv6
-@cindex IPv6
-Run using the IPv6 protocol (otherwise, @mhd{} will just support IPv4).
-
-
-@item MHD_USE_PEDANTIC_CHECKS
-Be pedantic about the protocol (as opposed to as tolerant as possible).
-Specifically, at the moment, this flag causes @mhd{} to reject @http{}
-1.1 connections without a @code{Host} header. This is required by the
-standard, but of course in violation of the ``be as liberal as possible
-in what you accept'' norm. It is recommended to turn this @strong{ON}
-if you are testing clients against @mhd{}, and @strong{OFF} in
-production.
-
-@item MHD_USE_POLL
-@cindex FD_SETSIZE
-@cindex poll
-@cindex select
-Use poll instead of select. This allows sockets with descriptors
-@code{>= FD_SETSIZE}. This option only works in conjunction with
-@code{MHD_USE_THREAD_PER_CONNECTION} (at this point).
-
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_OPTION
-@mhd{} options. Passed in the varargs portion of
-@cfunction{MHD_start_daemon}.
-
-@table @code
-@item MHD_OPTION_END
-No more options / last option. This is used to terminate the VARARGs
-list.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_CONNECTION_MEMORY_LIMIT
-@cindex memory, limiting memory utilization
-Maximum memory size per connection (followed by a @code{size_t}). The
-default is 32 kB (32*1024 bytes) as defined by the internal constant
-@code{MHD_POOL_SIZE_DEFAULT}.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_CONNECTION_LIMIT
-@cindex connection, limiting number of connections
-Maximum number of concurrenct connections to accept (followed by an
-@code{unsigned int}). The default is @code{FD_SETSIZE - 4} (the
-maximum number of file descriptors supported by @code{select} minus
-four for @code{stdin}, @code{stdout}, @code{stderr} and the server
-socket). In other words, the default is as large as possible.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_CONNECTION_TIMEOUT
-@cindex timeout
-After how many seconds of inactivity should a connection automatically
-be timed out? (followed by an @code{unsigned int}; use zero for no
-timeout). The default is zero (no timeout).
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED
-Register a function that should be called whenever a request has been
-completed (this can be used for application-specific clean up).
-Requests that have never been presented to the application (via
-@cfunction{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback}) will not result in
-notifications.
-
-This option should be followed by @strong{TWO} pointers. First a
-pointer to a function of type @cfunction{MHD_RequestCompletedCallback}
-and second a pointer to a closure to pass to the request completed
-callback. The second pointer maybe @mynull{}.
-
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_PER_IP_CONNECTION_LIMIT
-Limit on the number of (concurrent) connections made to the
-server from the same IP address. Can be used to prevent one
-IP from taking over all of the allowed connections. If the
-same IP tries to establish more than the specified number of
-connections, they will be immediately rejected. The option
-should be followed by an @code{unsigned int}. The default is
-zero, which means no limit on the number of connections
-from the same IP address.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_SOCK_ADDR
-@cindex bind, restricting bind
-Bind daemon to the supplied socket address. This option should be followed by a
-@code{struct sockaddr *}. If @code{MHD_USE_IPv6} is specified,
-the @code{struct sockaddr*} should point to a @code{struct sockaddr_in6},
-otherwise to a @code{struct sockaddr_in}. If this option is not specified,
-the daemon will listen to incomming connections from anywhere.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_URI_LOG_CALLBACK
-@cindex debugging
-@cindex logging
-@cindex query string
-Specify a function that should be called before parsing the URI from
-the client. The specified callback function can be used for processing
-the URI (including the options) before it is parsed. The URI after
-parsing will no longer contain the options, which maybe inconvenient for
-logging. This option should be followed by two arguments, the first
-one must be of the form
-@example
- void * my_logger(void * cls, const char * uri)
-@end example
-where the return value will be passed as
-@code{*con_cls} in calls to the @code{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback}
-when this request is processed later; returning a
-value of NULL has no special significance; (however,
-note that if you return non-NULL, you can no longer
-rely on the first call to the access handler having
-@code{NULL == *con_cls on entry} on entry)
-@code{cls} will be set to the second argument following
-MHD_OPTION_URI_LOG_CALLBACK. Finally, @code{uri} will
-be the 0-terminated URI of the request.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_KEY
-Memory pointer to the private key to be used by the
-HTTPS daemon. This option should be followed by an
-"const char*" argument.
-This should be used in conjunction with 'MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_CERT'.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_CERT
-Memory pointer to the certificate to be used by the
-HTTPS daemon. This option should be followed by an
-"const char*" argument.
-This should be used in conjunction with 'MHD_OPTION_HTTPS_MEM_KEY'.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_CRED_TYPE
-Daemon credentials type. Either certificate or anonymous,
-this option should be followed by one of the values listed in
-"enum MHD_GNUTLS_CredentialsType".
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_PROTOCOL_VERSION
-SSL/TLS protocol version.
-Memory pointer to a zero (MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_END) terminated
-(const) array of 'enum MHD_GNUTLS_Protocol' values representing the
-protocol versions to this server should support. Unsupported
-requests will be dropped by the server.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_CIPHER_ALGORITHM
-Memory pointer to a zero (MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_UNKNOWN)
-terminated (const) array of 'enum MHD_GNUTLS_CipherAlgorithm'
-representing the cipher priority order to which the HTTPS
-daemon should adhere.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_EXTERNAL_LOGGER
-@cindex logging
-Use the given function for logging error messages.
-This option must be followed by two arguments; the
-first must be a pointer to a function
-of type 'void fun(void * arg, const char * fmt, va_list ap)'
-and the second a pointer of type 'void*' which will
-be passed as the "arg" argument to "fun".
-
-Note that MHD will not generate any log messages
-if it was compiled without the "--enable-messages"
-flag being set and the MHD_USE_DEBUG flag being set,
-even if this argument is used.
-
-@item MHD_OPTION_ARRAY
-@cindex options
-This option can be used for initializing MHD using options from an
-array. A common use for this is writing an FFI for MHD. The actual
-options given are in an array of 'struct MHD_OptionItem', so this
-option requires a single argument of type 'struct MHD_OptionItem'.
-The array must be terminated with an entry @code{MHD_OPTION_END}.
-
-An example for code using MHD_OPTION_ARRAY is:
-@example
-struct MHD_OptionItem ops[] = @{
- @{ MHD_OPTION_CONNECTION_LIMIT, 100, NULL @},
- @{ MHD_OPTION_CONNECTION_TIMEOUT, 10, NULL @},
- @{ MHD_OPTION_END, 0, NULL @}
-@};
-d = MHD_start_daemon(0, 8080, NULL, NULL, dh, NULL,
- MHD_OPTION_ARRAY, ops,
- MHD_OPTION_END);
-@end example
-For options that expect a single pointer argument, the
-second member of the @code{struct MHD_OptionItem} is ignored.
-For options that expect two pointer arguments, the first
-argument must be cast to @code{intptr_t}.
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {C Struct} MHD_OptionItem
-Entry in an MHD_OPTION_ARRAY. See the @code{MHD_OPTION_ARRAY} option
-argument for its use.
-
-The @code{option} member is used to specify which option is specified
-in the array. The other members specify the respective argument.
-
-Note that for options taking only a single pointer, the
-@code{ptr_value} member should be set. For options taking two pointer
-arguments, the first pointer must be cast to @code{intptr_t} and both
-the @code{value} and the @code{ptr_value} members should be used to
-pass the two pointers.
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_ValueKind
-The @code{MHD_ValueKind} specifies the source of the key-value pairs in
-the @http{} protocol.
-
-@table @code
-@item MHD_RESPONSE_HEADER_KIND
-Response header.
-
-@item MHD_HEADER_KIND
-@http{} header.
-
-@item MHD_COOKIE_KIND
-@cindex cookie
-Cookies. Note that the original @http{} header containing the cookie(s)
-will still be available and intact.
-
-@item MHD_POSTDATA_KIND
-@cindex POST method
-@code{POST} data. This is available only if a content encoding
-supported by @mhd{} is used (currently only @acronym{URL} encoding), and
-only if the posted content fits within the available memory pool. Note
-that in that case, the upload data given to the
-@cfunction{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback} will be empty (since it has
-already been processed).
-
-@item MHD_GET_ARGUMENT_KIND
-@code{GET} (@uri{}) arguments.
-
-@item MHD_HEADER_KIND
-@http{} footer (only for http 1.1 chunked encodings).
-
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_RequestTerminationCode
-The @code{MHD_RequestTerminationCode} specifies reasons why a request
-has been terminated (or completed).
-
-@table @code
-@item MHD_REQUEST_TERMINATED_COMPLETED_OK
-We finished sending the response.
-
-@item MHD_REQUEST_TERMINATED_WITH_ERROR
-Error handling the connection (resources exhausted, other side closed
-connection, application error accepting request, etc.)
-
-@item MHD_REQUEST_TERMINATED_TIMEOUT_REACHED
-No activity on the connection for the number of seconds specified using
-@code{MHD_OPTION_CONNECTION_TIMEOUT}.
-
-@item MHD_REQUEST_TERMINATED_DAEMON_SHUTDOWN
-We had to close the session since @mhd{} was being shut down.
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_GNUTLS_Protocol
-SSL/TLS Protocol types. Note that not all listed algorithms are
-necessarily supported by all builds of MHD.
-
-@table @code
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_END
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_SSL3
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_TLS1_0
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_TLS1_1
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_TLS1_2
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_PROTOCOL_UNKNOWN
-
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_GNUTLS_CipherAlgorithm
-List of symmetric ciphers.
-Note that not all listed algorithms are necessarily supported by
-all builds of MHD.
-
-@table @code
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_UNKNOWN
-
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_NULL
-
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_ARCFOUR_128
-
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_3DES_CBC
-
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_AES_128_CBC
-
-@item MHD_GNUTLS_CIPHER_AES_256_CBC
-
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_ConnectionInfoType
-Values of this enum are used to specify what information about a
-connection is desired.
-
-@table @code
-
-@item MHD_CONNECTION_INFO_CIPHER_ALGO
-What cipher algorithm is being used.
-Takes no extra arguments.
-
-@item MHD_CONNECTION_INFO_PROTOCOL,
-Takes no extra arguments.
-
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-
-
-@deftp {Enumeration} MHD_DaemonInfoType
-Values of this enum are used to specify what
-information about a deamon is desired.
-@table @code
-@item MHD_DAEMON_INFO_KEY_SIZE
-Request information about the key size for a particular cipher
-algorithm. The cipher algorithm should be passed as an extra argument
-(of type 'enum MHD_GNUTLS_CipherAlgorithm').
-
-@item MHD_DAEMON_INFO_MAC_KEY_SIZE
-Request information about the key size for a particular cipher
-algorithm. The cipher algorithm should be passed as an extra argument
-(of type 'enum MHD_GNUTLS_HashAlgorithm').
-
-@item MHD_DAEMON_INFO_LISTEN_FD
-@cindex listen
-Request the file-descriptor number that MHD is using to listen to the
-server socket. This can be useful if no port
-was specified and a client needs to learn what port
-is actually being used by MHD.
-No extra arguments should be passed.
-
-@end table
-@end deftp
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-struct
-@chapter Structures type definition
-
-
-@deftp {C Struct} MHD_Daemon
-Handle for the daemon (listening on a socket for @http{} traffic).
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {C Struct} MHD_Connection
-Handle for a connection / @http{} request. With @http{}/1.1, multiple
-requests can be run over the same connection. However, @mhd{} will only
-show one request per @tcp{} connection to the client at any given time.
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {C Struct} MHD_Response
-Handle for a response.
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {C Struct} MHD_PostProcessor
-@cindex POST method
-Handle for @code{POST} processing.
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {C Union} MHD_ConnectionInfo
-Information about a connection.
-@end deftp
-
-
-@deftp {C Union} MHD_DaemonInfo
-Information about an MHD daemon.
-@end deftp
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-cb
-@chapter Callback functions definition
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} int {*MHD_AcceptPolicyCallback} (void *cls, const struct sockaddr * addr, socklen_t addrlen)
-Invoked in the context of a connection to allow or deny a client to
-connect. This callback return @code{MHD_YES} if connection is allowed,
-@code{MHD_NO} if not.
-
-@table @var
-@item cls
-custom value selected at callback registration time;
-@item addr
-address information from the client;
-@item addrlen
-length of the address information.
-@end table
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} int {*MHD_AccessHandlerCallback} (void *cls, struct MHD_Connection * connection, const char *url, const char *method, const char *version, const char *upload_data, size_t *upload_data_size, void **con_cls)
-Invoked in the context of a connection to answer a request from the
-client. This callback must call @mhd{} functions (example: the
-@code{MHD_Response} ones) to provide content to give back to the client
-and return an @http{} status code (i.e. @code{200} for OK, @code{404},
-etc.).
-
-@ref{microhttpd-post}, for details on how to code this callback.
-
-Must return @code{MHD_YES} if the connection was handled successfully,
-@code{MHD_NO} if the socket must be closed due to a serious error while
-handling the request
-
-@table @var
-@item cls
-custom value selected at callback registration time;
-
-@item url
-the @urloc{} requested by the client;
-
-@item method
-the @http{} method used by the client (@code{GET}, @code{PUT},
-@code{DELETE}, @code{POST}, etc.);
-
-@item version
-the @http{} version string (i.e. @code{HTTP/1.1});
-
-@item upload_data
-the data being uploaded (excluding headers):
-@cindex POST method
-@cindex PUT method
-
-@itemize
-@item
-for a @code{POST} that fits into memory and that is encoded with a
-supported encoding, the @code{POST} data will @strong{NOT} be given in
-@var{upload_data} and is instead available as part of
-@cfunction{MHD_get_connection_values};
-
-@item
-very large @code{POST} data @strong{will} be made available
-incrementally in @var{upload_data};
-@end itemize
-
-@item upload_data_size
-set initially to the size of the @var{upload_data} provided; this
-callback must update this value to the number of bytes @strong{NOT}
-processed; unless external select is used, the callback maybe
-required to process at least some data. If the callback fails to
-process data in multi-threaded or internal-select mode and if the
-read-buffer is already at the maximum size that MHD is willing to
-use for reading (about half of the maximum amount of memory allowed
-for the connection), then MHD will abort handling the connection
-and return an internal server error to the client. In order to
-avoid this, clients must be able to process upload data incrementally
-and reduce the value of @code{upload_data_size}.
-
-@item con_cls
-reference to a pointer, initially set to @mynull{}, that this callback can
-set to some address and that will be preserved by @mhd{} for future
-calls for this request;
-
-since the access handler may be called many times (i.e., for a
-@code{PUT}/@code{POST} operation with plenty of upload data) this allows
-the application to easily associate some request-specific state;
-
-if necessary, this state can be cleaned up in the global
-@code{MHD_RequestCompletedCallback} (which can be set with the
-@code{MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED}).
-@end table
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} void {*MHD_RequestCompletedCallback} (void *cls, struct MHD_Connectionconnection, void **con_cls, enum MHD_RequestTerminationCode toe)
-Signature of the callback used by @mhd{} to notify the application about
-completed requests.
-
-@table @var
-@item cls
-custom value selected at callback registration time;
-
-@item connection
-connection handle;
-
-@item con_cls
-value as set by the last call to the
-@code{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback};
-
-@item toe
-reason for request termination see @code{MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED}.
-@end table
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} int {*MHD_KeyValueIterator} (void *cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key, const char *value)
-Iterator over key-value pairs. This iterator can be used to iterate
-over all of the cookies, headers, or @code{POST}-data fields of a
-request, and also to iterate over the headers that have been added to a
-response.
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} to continue iterating, @code{MHD_NO} to abort the
-iteration.
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} int {*MHD_ContentReaderCallback} (void *cls, uint64_t pos, char *buf, int max)
-Callback used by @mhd{} in order to obtain content. The callback has to
-copy at most @var{max} bytes of content into @var{buf}. The total
-number of bytes that has been placed into @var{buf} should be returned.
-
-Note that returning zero will cause @mhd{} to try again, either
-``immediately'' if in multi-threaded mode (in which case the callback
-may want to do blocking operations to avoid busy waiting) or in the
-next round if @code{MHD_run} is used. Returning zero for a daemon
-that runs in internal @cfunction{select} mode is an error (since it
-would result in busy waiting) and cause the program to be aborted
-(@cfunction{abort}).
-
-@table @var
-@item cls
-custom value selected at callback registration time;
-
-@item pos
-position in the datastream to access; note that if an
-@code{MHD_Response} object is re-used, it is possible for the same
-content reader to be queried multiple times for the same data; however,
-if an @code{MHD_Response} is not re-used, @mhd{} guarantees that
-@var{pos} will be the sum of all non-negative return values obtained
-from the content reader so far.
-@end table
-
-Return @code{-1} on error (@mhd{} will no longer try to read content and
-instead close the connection with the client).
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} void {*MHD_ContentReaderFreeCallback} (void *cls)
-This method is called by @mhd{} if we are done with a content reader.
-It should be used to free resources associated with the content reader.
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@deftypefn {Function Pointer} int {*MHD_PostDataIterator} (void *cls, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key, const char *filename, const char *content_type, const char *transfer_encoding, const char *data, uint64_t off, size_t size)
-Iterator over key-value pairs where the value maybe made available in
-increments and/or may not be zero-terminated. Used for processing
-@code{POST} data.
-
-@table @var
-@item cls
-custom value selected at callback registration time;
-
-@item kind
-type of the value;
-
-@item key
-zero-terminated key for the value;
-
-@item filename
-name of the uploaded file, @mynull{} if not known;
-
-@item content_type
-mime-type of the data, @mynull{} if not known;
-
-@item transfer_encoding
-encoding of the data, @mynull{} if not known;
-
-@item data
-pointer to size bytes of data at the specified offset;
-
-@item off
-offset of data in the overall value;
-
-@item size
-number of bytes in data available.
-@end table
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} to continue iterating, @code{MHD_NO} to abort the
-iteration.
-@end deftypefn
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-init
-@chapter Starting and stopping the server
-
-@deftypefun {void} MHD_set_panic_func (MHD_PanicCallback cb, void *cls)
-Set a handler for fatal errors.
-
-@table @var
-@item cb
-function to call if MHD encounteres a fatal internal error. If no handler was set explicitly, MHD will call @code{abort}.
-
-@item cls
-closure argument for cb; the other arguments are the name of the source file, line number and a string describing the nature of the fatal error (which can be NULL)
-@end table
-@end deftypefun
-
-@deftypefun {struct MHD_Daemon *} MHD_start_daemon (unsigned int flags, unsigned short port, MHD_AcceptPolicyCallback apc, void *apc_cls, MHD_AccessHandlerCallback dh, void *dh_cls, ...)
-Start a webserver on the given port.
-
-@table @var
-@item flags
-OR-ed combination of @code{MHD_FLAG} values;
-
-@item port
-port to bind to;
-
-@item apc
-callback to call to check which clients will be allowed to connect; you
-can pass @mynull{} in which case connections from any @acronym{IP} will be
-accepted;
-
-@item apc_cls
-extra argument to @var{apc};
-
-@item dh
-default handler for all @uri{}s;
-
-@item dh_cls
-extra argument to @var{dh}.
-@end table
-
-Additional arguments are a list of options (type-value pairs,
-terminated with @code{MHD_OPTION_END}). It is mandatory to use
-@code{MHD_OPTION_END} as last argument, even when there are no
-additional arguments.
-
-Return @mynull{} on error, handle to daemon on success.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun void MHD_stop_daemon (struct MHD_Daemon *daemon)
-Shutdown an @http{} daemon.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_run (struct MHD_Daemon *daemon)
-Run webserver operations (without blocking unless in client callbacks).
-This method should be called by clients in combination with
-@cfunction{MHD_get_fdset} if the client-controlled @cfunction{select}
-method is used.
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} on success, @code{MHD_NO} if this daemon was not
-started with the right options for this call.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c -----------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-inspect
-@chapter Implementing external @code{select}
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_get_fdset (struct MHD_Daemon *daemon, fd_set * read_fd_set, fd_set * write_fd_set, fd_set * except_fd_set, int *max_fd)
-Obtain the @cfunction{select} sets for this daemon. The daemon's socket
-is added to @var{read_fd_set}. The list of currently existent
-connections is scanned and their file descriptors added to the correct
-set.
-
-@glibcref{Waiting for I/O}, for details on file descriptor sets.
-
-After the call completed successfully: the variable referenced by
-@var{max_fd} references the file descriptor with highest integer
-identifier. The variable must be set to zero before invoking this
-function.
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} on success, @code{MHD_NO} if: the arguments are
-invalid (example: @mynull{} pointers); this daemon was not started with
-the right options for this call.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_get_timeout (struct MHD_Daemon *daemon, unsigned long long *timeout)
-@cindex timeout
-Obtain timeout value for select for this daemon (only needed if
-connection timeout is used). The returned value is how long
-@cfunction{select} should at most block, not the timeout value set for
-connections.
-
-@table @var
-@cindex timeout
-set to the timeout (in milliseconds).
-@end table
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} on success, @code{MHD_NO} if timeouts are not used
-(or no connections exist that would necessiate the use of a timeout
-right now).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c -----------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-requests
-@chapter Handling requests
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_get_connection_values (struct MHD_Connection *connection, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, MHD_KeyValueIterator iterator, void *iterator_cls)
-Get all the headers matching @var{kind} from the request.
-
-The @var{iterator} callback is invoked once for each header, with
-@var{iterator_cls} as first argument. Return the number of entries
-iterated over; this can be less than the number of headers if, while
-iterating, @var{iterator} returns @code{MHD_NO}.
-
-@var{iterator} can be @mynull{}: in this case this function just counts
-and returns the number of headers.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_set_connection_value (struct MHD_Connection *connection, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char * key, const char * value)
-This function can be used to add an entry to
-the HTTP headers of a connection (so that the
-MHD_get_connection_values function will return
-them -- and the MHD PostProcessor will also
-see them). This maybe required in certain
-situations (see Mantis #1399) where (broken)
-HTTP implementations fail to supply values needed
-by the post processor (or other parts of the
-application).
-
-This function MUST only be called from within
-the MHD_AccessHandlerCallback (otherwise, access
-maybe improperly synchronized). Furthermore,
-the client must guarantee that the key and
-value arguments are 0-terminated strings that
-are NOT freed until the connection is closed.
-(The easiest way to do this is by passing only
-arguments to permanently allocated strings.).
-
-@var{connection} is the connection for which
-the entry for @var{key} of the given @var{kind}
-should be set to the given @var{value}.
-
-The function returns @code{MHD_NO} if the operation
-could not be performed due to insufficient memory
-and @code{MHD_YES} on success.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun {const char *} MHD_lookup_connection_value (struct MHD_Connection *connection, enum MHD_ValueKind kind, const char *key)
-Get a particular header value. If multiple values match the @var{kind},
-return one of them (the ``first'', whatever that means). @var{key} must
-reference a zero-terminated @ascii{}-coded string representing the
-header to look for: it is compared against the headers using
-@cfunction{strcasecmp}, so case is ignored. Return @mynull{} if no such
-item was found.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-responses
-@chapter Building answers to responses
-
-
-@noindent
-Response objects handling by @mhd{} is asynchronous with respect to the
-application execution flow. Instances of the @code{MHD_Response}
-structure are not associated to a daemon and neither to a client
-connection: they are managed with reference counting.
-
-In the simplest case: we allocate a new @code{MHD_Response} structure
-for each response, we use it once and finally we destroy it.
-
-@mhd{} allows more efficient resources usages.
-
-Example: we allocate a new @code{MHD_Response} structure for each
-response @strong{kind}, we use it every time we have to give that
-responce and we finally destroy it only when the daemon shuts down.
-
-@menu
-* microhttpd-response enqueue:: Enqueuing a response.
-* microhttpd-response create:: Creating a response object.
-* microhttpd-response headers:: Adding headers to a response.
-* microhttpd-response inspect:: Inspecting a response object.
-@end menu
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-response enqueue
-@section Enqueuing a response
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_queue_response (struct MHD_Connection *connection, unsigned int status_code, struct MHD_Response *response)
-Queue a response to be transmitted to the client as soon as possible
-but only after MHD_AccessHandlerCallback returns. This function
-checks that it is legal to queue a response at this time for the
-given connection. It also increments the internal reference
-counter for the response object (the counter will be decremented
-automatically once the response has been transmitted).
-
-@table @var
-@item connection
-the connection identifying the client;
-
-@item status_code
-@http{} status code (i.e. @code{200} for OK);
-
-@item response
-response to transmit.
-@end table
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} on success or if message has been queued. Return
-@code{MHD_NO}: if arguments are invalid (example: @mynull{} pointer); on
-error (i.e. reply already sent).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun void MHD_destroy_response (struct MHD_Response *response)
-Destroy a response object and associated resources (decrement the
-reference counter). Note that @mhd{} may keep some of the resources
-around if the response is still in the queue for some clients, so the
-memory may not necessarily be freed immediatley.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-An explanation of reference counting@footnote{Note to readers acquainted
-to the Tcl @api{}: reference counting on @code{MHD_Connection}
-structures is handled in the same way as Tcl handles @code{Tcl_Obj}
-structures through @cfunction{Tcl_IncrRefCount} and
-@cfunction{Tcl_DecrRefCount}.}:
-
-@enumerate
-@item
-a @code{MHD_Response} object is allocated:
-
-@example
-struct MHD_Response * response = MHD_create_response_from_data(...);
-/* here: reference counter = 1 */
-@end example
-
-@item
-the @code{MHD_Response} object is enqueued in a @code{MHD_Connection}:
-
-@example
-MHD_queue_response(connection, , response);
-/* here: reference counter = 2 */
-@end example
-
-@item
-the creator of the response object discharges responsibility for it:
-
-@example
-MHD_destroy_response(response);
-/* here: reference counter = 1 */
-@end example
-
-@item
-the daemon handles the connection sending the response's data to the
-client then decrements the reference counter by calling
-@cfunction{MHD_destroy_response}: the counter's value drops to zero and
-the @code{MHD_Response} object is released.
-@end enumerate
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-response create
-@section Creating response objects
-
-
-@deftypefun {struct MHD_Response *} MHD_create_response_from_callback (uint64_t size, size_t block_size, MHD_ContentReaderCallback crc, void *crc_cls, MHD_ContentReaderFreeCallback crfc)
-Create a response object. The response object can be extended with
-header information and then it can be used any number of times.
-
-@table @var
-@item size
-size of the data portion of the response, @code{-1} for unknown;
-
-@item block_size
-preferred block size for querying @var{crc} (advisory only, @mhd{} may
-still call @var{crc} using smaller chunks); this is essentially the
-buffer size used for @acronym{IO}, clients should pick a value that is
-appropriate for @acronym{IO} and memory performance requirements;
-
-@item crc
-callback to use to obtain response data;
-
-@item crc_cls
-extra argument to @var{crc};
-
-@item crfc
-callback to call to free @var{crc_cls} resources.
-@end table
-
-Return @mynull{} on error (i.e. invalid arguments, out of memory).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun {struct MHD_Response *} MHD_create_response_from_data (size_t size, void *data, int must_free, int must_copy)
-Create a response object. The response object can be extended with
-header information and then it can be used any number of times.
-
-@table @var
-@item size
-size of the data portion of the response;
-
-@item data
-the data itself;
-
-@item must_free
-if true: @mhd{} should free data when done;
-
-@item must_copy
-if true: @mhd{} allocates a block of memory and use it to make a copy of
-@var{data} embedded in the returned @code{MHD_Response} structure;
-handling of the embedded memory is responsibility of @mhd{}; @var{data}
-can be released anytime after this call returns.
-@end table
-
-Return @mynull{} on error (i.e. invalid arguments, out of memory).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-Example: create a response from a statically allocated string:
-
-@example
-const char * data = "<html><body><p>Error!</p></body></html>";
-
-struct MHD_Connection * connection = ...;
-struct MHD_Response * response;
-
-response = MHD_create_response_from_data(strlen(data), data,
- MHD_NO, MHD_NO);
-MHD_queue_response(connection, 404, response);
-MHD_destroy_response(response);
-@end example
-
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-response headers
-@section Adding headers to a response
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_add_response_header (struct MHD_Response *response, const char *header, const char *content)
-Add a header line to the response. The strings referenced by
-@var{header} and @var{content} must be zero-terminated and they are
-duplicated into memory blocks embedded in @var{response}.
-
-Notice that the strings must not hold newlines, carriage returns or tab
-chars.
-
-Return @code{MHD_NO} on error (i.e. invalid header or content format or
-memory allocation error).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_del_response_header (struct MHD_Response *response, const char *header, const char *content)
-Delete a header line from the response. Return @code{MHD_NO} on error
-(arguments are invalid or no such header known).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-response inspect
-@section Inspecting a response object
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_get_response_headers (struct MHD_Response *response, MHD_KeyValueIterator iterator, void *iterator_cls)
-Get all of the headers added to a response.
-
-Invoke the @var{iterator} callback for each header in the response,
-using @var{iterator_cls} as first argument. Return number of entries
-iterated over. @var{iterator} can be @mynull{}: in this case the function
-just counts headers.
-
-@var{iterator} should not modify the its key and value arguments, unless
-we know what we are doing.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun {const char *} MHD_get_response_header (struct MHD_Response *response, const char *key)
-Find and return a pointer to the value of a particular header from the
-response. @var{key} must reference a zero-terminated string
-representing the header to look for. The search is case sensitive.
-Return @mynull{} if header does not exist or @var{key} is @mynull{}.
-
-We should not modify the value, unless we know what we are doing.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-post
-@chapter Adding a @code{POST} processor
-@cindex POST method
-
-@menu
-* microhttpd-post api:: Programming interface for the
- @code{POST} processor.
-@end menu
-
-
-@noindent
-@mhd{} provides the post procesor API to make it easier for applications to
-parse the data of a client's @code{POST} request: the
-@code{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback} will be invoked multiple times to
-process data as it arrives; at each invocation a new chunk of data must
-be processed. The arguments @var{upload_data} and @var{upload_data_size}
-are used to reference the chunk of data.
-
-When @code{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback} is invoked for a new connection:
-its @code{*@var{con_cls}} argument is set to @mynull{}. When @code{POST}
-data comes in the upload buffer it is @strong{mandatory} to use the
-@var{con_cls} to store a reference to per-connection data. The fact
-that the pointer was initially @mynull{} can be used to detect that
-this is a new request.
-
-One method to detect that a new connection was established is
-to set @code{*con_cls} to anunused integer:
-
-@example
-int
-access_handler (void *cls,
- struct MHD_Connection * connection,
- const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version,
- const char *upload_data, size_t *upload_data_size,
- void **con_cls)
-@{
- static int old_connection_marker;
- int new_connection = (MYNULL == *con_cls);
-
- if (new_connection)
- @{
- /* new connection with POST */
- *con_cls = &old_connection_marker;
- @}
-
- ...
-@}
-@end example
-
-@noindent
-In contrast to the previous example, for @code{POST} requests in particular,
-it is more common to use the value of @code{*con_cls} to keep track of
-actual state used during processing, such as the post processor (or a
-struct containing a post processor):
-
-@example
-int
-access_handler (void *cls,
- struct MHD_Connection * connection,
- const char *url,
- const char *method, const char *version,
- const char *upload_data, size_t *upload_data_size,
- void **con_cls)
-@{
- struct MHD_PostProcessor * pp = *con_cls;
-
- if (pp == NULL)
- @{
- pp = MHD_create_post_processor(connection, ...);
- *con_cls = pp;
- return MHD_YES;
- @}
- if (*upload_data_size)
- @{
- MHD_post_process(pp, upload_data, *upload_data_size);
- *upload_data_size = 0;
- return MHD_YES;
- @}
- else
- @{
- MHD_destroy_post_processor(pp);
- return MHD_queue_response(...);
- @}
-@}
-@end example
-
-Note that the callback from @code{MHD_OPTION_NOTIFY_COMPLETED}
-should be used to destroy the post processor. This cannot be
-done inside of the access handler since the connection may not
-always terminate normally.
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-post api
-@section Programming interface for the @code{POST} processor
-@cindex POST method
-
-@deftypefun {struct MHD_PostProcessor *} MHD_create_post_processor (struct MHD_Connection *connection, size_t buffer_size, MHD_PostDataIterator iterator, void *iterator_cls)
-Create a PostProcessor. A PostProcessor can be used to (incrementally)
-parse the data portion of a @code{POST} request.
-
-@table @var
-@item connection
-the connection on which the @code{POST} is happening (used to determine
-the @code{POST} format);
-
-@item buffer_size
-maximum number of bytes to use for internal buffering (used only for the
-parsing, specifically the parsing of the keys). A tiny value (256-1024)
-should be sufficient; do @strong{NOT} use a value smaller than 256;
-
-@item iterator
-iterator to be called with the parsed data; must @strong{NOT} be
-@mynull{};
-
-@item iterator_cls
-custom value to be used as first argument to @var{iterator}.
-@end table
-
-Return @mynull{} on error (out of memory, unsupported encoding), otherwise
-a PP handle.
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_post_process (struct MHD_PostProcessor *pp, const char *post_data, size_t post_data_len)
-Parse and process @code{POST} data. Call this function when @code{POST}
-data is available (usually during an @code{MHD_AccessHandlerCallback})
-with the @var{upload_data} and @var{upload_data_size}. Whenever
-possible, this will then cause calls to the
-@code{MHD_IncrementalKeyValueIterator}.
-
-@table @var
-@item pp
-the post processor;
-
-@item post_data
-@var{post_data_len} bytes of @code{POST} data;
-
-@item post_data_len
-length of @var{post_data}.
-@end table
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} on success, @code{MHD_NO} on error
-(out-of-memory, iterator aborted, parse error).
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-@deftypefun int MHD_destroy_post_processor (struct MHD_PostProcessor *pp)
-Release PostProcessor resources. After this function is being called,
-the PostProcessor is guaranteed to no longer call its iterator. There
-is no special call to the iterator to indicate the end of the post processing
-stream. After destroying the PostProcessor, the programmer should
-perform any necessary work to complete the processing of the iterator.
-
-Return @code{MHD_YES} if processing completed nicely, @code{MHD_NO}
-if there were spurious characters or formatting problems with
-the post request. It is common to ignore the return value
-of this function.
-
-
-@end deftypefun
-
-
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-info
-@chapter Obtaining status information.
-
-
-@menu
-* microhttpd-info daemon:: State information about an MHD daemon
-* microhttpd-info conn:: State information about a connection
-@end menu
-
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-info daemon
-@section Obtaining state information about an MHD daemon
-
-@deftypefun {const union MHD_DaemonInfo *} MHD_get_daemon_info (struct MHD_Daemon *daemon, enum MHD_DaemonInfoType infoType, ...)
-Obtain information about the given daemon. This function
-is currently not fully implemented.
-
-@table @var
-@item daemon
-the daemon about which information is desired;
-
-@item infoType
-type of information that is desired
-
-@item ...
-additional arguments about the desired information (depending on
-infoType)
-@end table
-
-Returns a union with the respective member (depending on
-infoType) set to the desired information), or NULL
-in case the desired information is not available or
-applicable.
-@end deftypefun
-
-@c ------------------------------------------------------------
-@node microhttpd-info conn
-@section Obtaining state information about a connection
-
-
-@deftypefun {const union MHD_ConnectionInfo *} MHD_get_connection_info (struct MHD_Connection *daemon, enum MHD_ConnectionInfoType infoType, ...)
-Obtain information about the given connection.
-
-@table @var
-@item connection
-the connection about which information is desired;
-
-@item infoType
-type of information that is desired
-
-@item ...
-additional arguments about the desired information (depending on
-infoType)
-@end table
-
-Returns a union with the respective member (depending on
-infoType) set to the desired information), or NULL
-in case the desired information is not available or
-applicable.
-@end deftypefun
-
-@c ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++
-
-
-@c **********************************************************
-@c ******************* Appendices *************************
-@c **********************************************************
-
-@node GNU-LGPL
-@unnumbered GNU-LGPL
-@cindex license
-@include lgpl.texi
-
-@node GNU GPL with eCos Extension
-@unnumbered GNU GPL with eCos Extension
-@cindex license
-@include ecos.texi
-
-@node GNU-FDL
-@unnumbered GNU-FDL
-@cindex license
-@include fdl-1.3.texi
-
-@node Concept Index
-@unnumbered Concept Index
-
-@printindex cp
-
-@node Function and Data Index
-@unnumbered Function and Data Index
-
-@printindex fn
-
-@node Type Index
-@unnumbered Type Index
-
-@printindex tp
-
-@bye
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/texinfo.tex b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/texinfo.tex
deleted file mode 100644
index 91408263bc..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/texinfo.tex
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,9291 +0,0 @@
-% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
-%
-% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
-\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
-%
-\def\texinfoversion{2009-08-14.15}
-%
-% Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
-% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
-% 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-%
-% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
-% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
-% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
-% License, or (at your option) any later version.
-%
-% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
-% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
-% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
-% General Public License for more details.
-%
-% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-% along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-%
-% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
-% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
-% restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
-%
-% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
-% reports; you can get the latest version from:
-% http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
-% ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
-% (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
-% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
-% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
-%
-% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
-% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
-% problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
-%
-% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
-% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
-% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
-% tex foo.texi
-% texindex foo.??
-% tex foo.texi
-% tex foo.texi
-% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
-% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
-% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
-% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
-%
-% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
-% extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
-% full Texinfo distribution.
-%
-% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
-
-
-\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
-
-% If in a .fmt file, print the version number
-% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
-% they might have appeared in the input file name.
-\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
- \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
-
-
-\chardef\other=12
-
-% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
-% For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
-\let\+ = \relax
-
-% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
-\let\ptexb=\b
-\let\ptexbullet=\bullet
-\let\ptexc=\c
-\let\ptexcomma=\,
-\let\ptexdot=\.
-\let\ptexdots=\dots
-\let\ptexend=\end
-\let\ptexequiv=\equiv
-\let\ptexexclam=\!
-\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
-\let\ptexgtr=>
-\let\ptexhat=^
-\let\ptexi=\i
-\let\ptexindent=\indent
-\let\ptexinsert=\insert
-\let\ptexlbrace=\{
-\let\ptexless=<
-\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
-\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
-\let\ptexplus=+
-\let\ptexrbrace=\}
-\let\ptexslash=\/
-\let\ptexstar=\*
-\let\ptext=\t
-\let\ptextop=\top
-{\catcode`\'=\active
-\global\let\ptexquoteright'}% Math-mode def from plain.tex.
-\let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
-
-% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
-% starts a new line in the output.
-\newlinechar = `^^J
-
-% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
-% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
-%
-\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
- \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
-\else
- \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
-\fi
-
-% Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
-\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
-\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
-\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
-\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
-\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
-\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
-\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
-\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
-\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
-\ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
-\ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
-\ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
-\ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
-\ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
-\ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
-\ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
-\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
-\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
-%
-\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
-\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
-%
-\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
-\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
-
-% Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
-\chardef\spacecat = 10
-\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
-
-% sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
-\chardef\colonChar = `\:
-\chardef\commaChar = `\,
-\chardef\dashChar = `\-
-\chardef\dotChar = `\.
-\chardef\exclamChar= `\!
-\chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
-\chardef\questChar = `\?
-\chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
-\chardef\semiChar = `\;
-\chardef\underChar = `\_
-
-% Ignore a token.
-%
-\def\gobble#1{}
-
-% The following is used inside several \edef's.
-\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
-
-% Hyphenation fixes.
-\hyphenation{
- Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
- ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
- data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
- man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
- par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
- spell-ing spell-ings
- stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
- wide-spread wrap-around
-}
-
-% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
-\newdimen\bindingoffset
-\newdimen\normaloffset
-\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
-
-% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
-% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
-% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
-%
-\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
-
-% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
-% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
-% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
-% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
-% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
-%
-\def\|{%
- % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
- \leavevmode
- %
- % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
- \vadjust{%
- % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
- % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
- \vskip-\baselineskip
- %
- % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
- % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
- \llap{%
- %
- % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
- \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
- %
- % This is the space between the bar and the text.
- \hskip 12pt
- }%
- }%
-}
-
-% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
-% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
-% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
-% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
-% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
-%
-\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
-\def\loggingall{%
- \tracingstats2
- \tracingpages1
- \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
- \tracingparagraphs1
- \tracingoutput1
- \tracingmacros2
- \tracingrestores1
- \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
- \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
- \tracingscantokens1
- \tracingifs1
- \tracinggroups1
- \tracingnesting2
- \tracingassigns1
- \fi
- \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
- \errorcontextlines16
-}%
-
-% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
-% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
-%
-\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
- \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
-\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
- \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
-\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
- \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
-
-% For @cropmarks command.
-% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
-%
-\newif\ifcropmarks
-\let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
-%
-% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
-% Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
-%
-\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
-\newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
-\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
-\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
-
-% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
-% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
-% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
-%
-% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
-% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
-%
-% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
-% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
-% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
-% described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
-% marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
-% one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
-\def\domark{%
- \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
- \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
- \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
- \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
- \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
- \mark{%
- \the\toks0 \the\toks2
- \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
- \noexpand\else \the\toks8
- }%
-}
-% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
-% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
-% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
-% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
-% first @chapter.
-\def\gettopheadingmarks{%
- \ifcase0\topmark\fi
- \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
-}
-\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
-\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
-
-% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
-\def\lastchapterdefs{}
-\def\lastsectiondefs{}
-\def\prevchapterdefs{}
-\def\prevsectiondefs{}
-\def\lastcolordefs{}
-
-% Main output routine.
-\chardef\PAGE = 255
-\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
-
-\newbox\headlinebox
-\newbox\footlinebox
-
-% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
-% does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
-\def\onepageout#1{%
- \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
- %
- \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
- \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
- %
- % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
- % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
- \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
- \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
- \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
- \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
- %
- {%
- % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
- % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
- % before the \shipout runs.
- %
- \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
- \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
- % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
- % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
- % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
- % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
- % it needs to be
- % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
- \shipout\vbox{%
- % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
- \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
- %
- \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
- \hsize = \outerhsize
- \vskip-\topandbottommargin
- \vtop to0pt{%
- \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
- \nointerlineskip
- \line{%
- \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
- \hfill
- \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
- }%
- \vss}%
- \vskip\topandbottommargin
- \line\bgroup
- \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
- \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
- \vbox\bgroup
- \fi
- %
- \unvbox\headlinebox
- \pagebody{#1}%
- \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
- % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
- % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
- % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
- \vskip 24pt
- \unvbox\footlinebox
- \fi
- %
- \ifcropmarks
- \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
- \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
- \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
- \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
- \vbox to0pt{\vss
- \line{%
- \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
- \hfill
- \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
- }%
- \nointerlineskip
- \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
- }%
- \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
- \fi
- }% end of \shipout\vbox
- }% end of group with \indexdummies
- \advancepageno
- \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
-}
-
-\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
-
-\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
-{\catcode`\@ =11
-\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
-% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
-\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
- \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
-\dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
-\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
-\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
-}
-
-% Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
-% offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
-% (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
-%
-\def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
-\def\nstop{\vbox
- {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
-\def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
-\def\nsbot{\vbox
- {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
-
-% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
-% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
-% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
-%
-\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
-\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
- \def\argtorun{#2}%
- \begingroup
- \obeylines
- \spaceisspace
- #1%
- \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
-}
-
-{\obeylines %
- \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
- \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
- \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
- }%
-}
-
-% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
-\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
-\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
-
-% Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
-%
-% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
-% @end itemize @c foo
-% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
-% by \finishparsearg.
-%
-\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
-\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
-\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
- \def\temp{#3}%
- \ifx\temp\empty
- % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
- \let\temp\finishparsearg
- \else
- \let\temp\argcheckspaces
- \fi
- % Put the space token in:
- \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
-}
-
-% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
-% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
-% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
-% just before passing the control to \argtorun.
-% (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
-% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
-% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
-%
-% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
-%
-\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
-
-% \parseargdef\foo{...}
-% is roughly equivalent to
-% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
-% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
-%
-% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
-% favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
-
-\def\parseargdef#1{%
- \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
-}
-\def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
- \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
- \def#1##1%
-}
-
-% Several utility definitions with active space:
-{
- \obeyspaces
- \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
-
- % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
- % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
- % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
- % should produce a line of output anyway.
- %
- \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
-
- % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
- % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
- % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
- \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
-}
-
-
-\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
-
-% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
-%
-% \envdef\foo{...}
-% \def\Efoo{...}
-%
-% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
-% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
-% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
-% whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
-% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
-%
-% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
-% are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
-% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
-% special case.)
-
-
-% At run-time, environments start with this:
-\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
-% initialize
-\let\thisenv\empty
-
-% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
-\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
-\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
-
-% Check whether we're in the right environment:
-\def\checkenv#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\thisenv\temp
- \else
- \badenverr
- \fi
-}
-
-% Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
-\def\badenverr{%
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
- not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
-}
-\def\inenvironment#1{%
- \ifx#1\empty
- out of any environment%
- \else
- in environment \expandafter\string#1%
- \fi
-}
-
-% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
-% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
-%
-\parseargdef\end{%
- \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
- \else
- % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
- \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
- \csname E#1\endcsname
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
-
-\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
-
-
-%% Simple single-character @ commands
-
-% @@ prints an @
-% Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
-\def\@{{\tt\char64}}
-
-% This is turned off because it was never documented
-% and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
-%% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
-%% but suppressing ligatures.
-%\def\`{{`}}
-%\def\'{{'}}
-
-% Used to generate quoted braces.
-\def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
-\def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
-\let\{=\mylbrace
-\let\}=\myrbrace
-\begingroup
- % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
- % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
- \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
- \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
- \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
- !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
- !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
- !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
- !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
-!endgroup
-
-% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
-\let\comma = ,
-
-% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
-% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
-\let\, = \c
-\let\dotaccent = \.
-\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
-\let\tieaccent = \t
-\let\ubaraccent = \b
-\let\udotaccent = \d
-
-% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
-% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
-\def\questiondown{?`}
-\def\exclamdown{!`}
-\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
-\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
-
-% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
-\def\imacro{i}
-\def\jmacro{j}
-\def\dotless#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
- \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
- \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
-% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
-%
-\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
-
-% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
-% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
-% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
-% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
-% \scriptscriptstyle).
-%
-\def\LaTeX{%
- L\kern-.36em
- {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
- \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
- \kern-.15em
- \TeX
-}
-
-% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
-% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
-% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
-% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
-% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
-{\catcode`@ = 11
- % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
- % if the definition is written into an index file.
- \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
- \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
-}
-
-% @: forces normal size whitespace following.
-\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
-
-% @* forces a line break.
-\def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
-
-% @/ allows a line break.
-\let\/=\allowbreak
-
-% @. is an end-of-sentence period.
-\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
-\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @? is an end-of-sentence query.
-\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
-%
-\def\onword{on}
-\def\offword{off}
-%
-\parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
- \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
-% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
-% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
-\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
-
-% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
-% it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
-% to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
-% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
-% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
-% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
-% the text is small, which looks bad.
-%
-% Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
-% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
-% does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
-% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
-% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
-% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
-%
-\newbox\groupbox
-\def\vfilllimit{0.7}
-%
-\envdef\group{%
- \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
- \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
- \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
- \fi
- \startsavinginserts
- %
- \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
- % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
- % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
- % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
- % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
- % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
- % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
- \comment
-}
-%
-% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
-% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
-% \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
-% above. But it's pretty close.
-\def\Egroup{%
- % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
- % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
- \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
- \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
- \egroup % End the \vtop.
- % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
- \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
- % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
- \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
- % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
- % group, force a page break.
- \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
- \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
- \page
- \fi
- \fi
- \box\groupbox
- \prevdepth = \dimen1
- \checkinserts
-}
-%
-% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
-% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
-%
-\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
-group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
-where each line of input produces a line of output.}
-
-% @need space-in-mils
-% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
-
-\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
-
-% Old definition--didn't work.
-%\parseargdef\need{\par %
-%% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
-%% if the depth of the box does not fit.
-%{\baselineskip=0pt%
-%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
-%\prevdepth=-1000pt
-%}}
-
-\parseargdef\need{%
- % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
- % paragraph.
- \par
- %
- % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
- \dimen0 = #1\mil
- \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
- \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
- \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
- %
- % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
- % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
- % And a page break here is fine.
- \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
- %
- % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
- % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
- % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
- % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
- % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
- %
- % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
- % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
- % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
- % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
- % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
- % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
- % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
- \penalty9999
- %
- % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
- \kern -#1\mil
- %
- % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
- \nobreak
- \fi
-}
-
-% @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
-
-\let\br = \par
-
-% @page forces the start of a new page.
-%
-\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
-
-% @exdent text....
-% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
-
-% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
-% That's how much \exdent should take out.
-\newskip\exdentamount
-
-% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
-\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
-
-% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
-\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
- \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
-
-% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
-% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
-% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
-%
-\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
-\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
-%
-\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
- \nobreak
- \kern-\strutdepth
- \vtop to \strutdepth{%
- \baselineskip=\strutdepth
- \vss
- % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
- % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
- \ifx#1l%
- \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
- \else
- \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
- \fi
- \null
- }%
-}}
-\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
-\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
-%
-% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
-% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
-% else use TEXT for both).
-%
-\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
-\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
- \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
- \def\righttext{#2}%
- \else
- \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
- \def\righttext{#1}%
- \fi
- %
- \ifodd\pageno
- \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
- \else
- \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
- \fi
- \temp
-}
-
-% @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
-%
-\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
-\def\includezzz#1{%
- \pushthisfilestack
- \def\thisfile{#1}%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
- \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
- \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
- %
- % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
- % definitions, etc.
- \expandafter
- }\temp
- \popthisfilestack
-}
-\def\filenamecatcodes{%
- \catcode`\\=\other
- \catcode`~=\other
- \catcode`^=\other
- \catcode`_=\other
- \catcode`|=\other
- \catcode`<=\other
- \catcode`>=\other
- \catcode`+=\other
- \catcode`-=\other
- \catcode`\`=\other
- \catcode`\'=\other
-}
-
-\def\pushthisfilestack{%
- \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
-}
-\def\pushthisfilestackX{%
- \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
-}
-\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
- \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
-}
-
-\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
-\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
- the stack of filenames is empty.}}
-
-\def\thisfile{}
-
-% @center line
-% outputs that line, centered.
-%
-\parseargdef\center{%
- \ifhmode
- \let\next\centerH
- \else
- \let\next\centerV
- \fi
- \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
-}
-\def\centerH#1{%
- {%
- \hfil\break
- \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
- \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
- \line{#1}%
- \break
- }%
-}
-\def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
-
-% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
-
-\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
-
-% @comment ...line which is ignored...
-% @c is the same as @comment
-% @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
-
-\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
-\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
-\commentxxx}
-{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
-
-\let\c=\comment
-
-% @paragraphindent NCHARS
-% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
-% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
-% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
-%
-\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
-\def\noneword{none}
-%
-\parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\asisword
- \else
- \ifx\temp\noneword
- \defaultparindent = 0pt
- \else
- \defaultparindent = #1em
- \fi
- \fi
- \parindent = \defaultparindent
-}
-
-% @exampleindent NCHARS
-% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
-% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
-% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
-\parseargdef\exampleindent{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\asisword
- \else
- \ifx\temp\noneword
- \lispnarrowing = 0pt
- \else
- \lispnarrowing = #1em
- \fi
- \fi
-}
-
-% @firstparagraphindent WORD
-% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
-% after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
-% paragraphs.
-%
-% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
-% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
-% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
-% By default, we suppress indentation.
-%
-\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\def\insertword{insert}
-%
-\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\noneword
- \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
- \else\ifx\temp\insertword
- \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
-% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
-%
-% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
-% paragraph.
-%
-\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
- \gdef\indent{%
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
- \indent
- }%
- \gdef\noindent{%
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
- \noindent
- }%
- \global\everypar = {%
- \kern -\parindent
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
- }%
-}
-
-\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
- \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
- \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
- \global \everypar = {}%
-}
-
-
-% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
-%
-\def\asis#1{#1}
-
-% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
-%
-% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
-% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
-% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
-% which is what @var uses.
-{
- \catcode`\_ = \active
- \gdef\mathunderscore{%
- \catcode`\_=\active
- \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
- }
-}
-% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
-% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
-% this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
-% otherwise define @\.
-%
-% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
-\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
-%
-\def\math{%
- \tex
- \mathunderscore
- \let\\ = \mathbackslash
- \mathactive
- % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
- \let\"=\ddot
- \let\'=\acute
- \let\==\bar
- \let\^=\hat
- \let\`=\grave
- \let\u=\breve
- \let\v=\check
- \let\~=\tilde
- \let\dotaccent=\dot
- $\finishmath
-}
-\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
-
-% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
-% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
-% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
-%
-{
- \catcode`^ = \active
- \catcode`< = \active
- \catcode`> = \active
- \catcode`+ = \active
- \catcode`' = \active
- \gdef\mathactive{%
- \let^ = \ptexhat
- \let< = \ptexless
- \let> = \ptexgtr
- \let+ = \ptexplus
- \let' = \ptexquoteright
- }
-}
-
-% Some math mode symbols.
-\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
-\def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi}
-\def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi}
-\def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi}
-
-% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
-% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
-% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
-% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
-% whichever is larger.
-%
-\def\dots{%
- \leavevmode
- \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
- \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
- \dimen0 = \wd0
- \else
- \dimen0 = 1.5em
- \fi
- \hbox to \dimen0{%
- \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
- .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
- }%
-}
-
-% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
-%
-\def\enddots{%
- \dots
- \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
-}
-
-% @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
-% Texinfo's parsing.
-%
-\let\comma = ,
-
-% @refill is a no-op.
-\let\refill=\relax
-
-% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
-% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
-% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
-%
-\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
-\let\novalidate = \linksfalse
-
-% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
-% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
-% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
-\def\setfilename{%
- \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
- \iflinks
- \tryauxfile
- % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
- \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
- \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
- \openindices
- \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
- %
- % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
- % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
- \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
- \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
- \closein 1
- %
- \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
-}
-
-% Called from \setfilename.
-%
-\def\openindices{%
- \newindex{cp}%
- \newcodeindex{fn}%
- \newcodeindex{vr}%
- \newcodeindex{tp}%
- \newcodeindex{ky}%
- \newcodeindex{pg}%
-}
-
-% @bye.
-\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
-
-
-\message{pdf,}
-% adobe `portable' document format
-\newcount\tempnum
-\newcount\lnkcount
-\newtoks\filename
-\newcount\filenamelength
-\newcount\pgn
-\newtoks\toksA
-\newtoks\toksB
-\newtoks\toksC
-\newtoks\toksD
-\newbox\boxA
-\newcount\countA
-\newif\ifpdf
-\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
-
-% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
-% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
-% borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
-\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
-\else
- \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
- \else
- \ifcase\pdfoutput
- \else
- \pdftrue
- \fi
- \fi
-\fi
-
-% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
-% for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
-% double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
-% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
-% http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
-% (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
-% user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
-% that's what we do).
-
-% double active backslashes.
-%
-{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
- @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
- @catcode`@\=@active
- @let\=@doublebackslash}
-}
-
-% To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
-% not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
-% us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
-% changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
-% from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
-%
-% #1 is the tokens to replace.
-% #2 is the replacement.
-% #3 is the control sequence with the string.
-%
-\def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
- \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
- ##1%
- \ifx\\##2\\%
- \else
- #2%
- \HyReturnAfterFi{%
- \HyPsdReplace##2\END
- }%
- \fi
- }%
- \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
-}
-\long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
-
-% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
-\def\backslashparens#1{%
- \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
- % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
- \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
- \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
-}
-
-\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
-with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
-be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
-output) for that.)}
-
-\ifpdf
- %
- % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex,
- % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
- % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
- % of actual black.
- \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
- \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
- %
- % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
- % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
- \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
- %
- % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
- % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
- \def\setcolor#1{%
- \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
- \domark
- \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
- }
- %
- \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
- \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
- \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
- \def\lastcolordefs{}
- %
- \def\makefootline{%
- \baselineskip24pt
- \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
- }
- %
- \def\makeheadline{%
- \vbox to 0pt{%
- \vskip-22.5pt
- \line{%
- \vbox to8.5pt{}%
- % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
- \getcolormarks
- % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
- \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
- }%
- \vss
- }%
- \nointerlineskip
- }
- %
- %
- \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
- %
- % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
- \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
- \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
- %
- % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
- % others). Let's try in that order.
- \let\pdfimgext=\empty
- \begingroup
- \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
- \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
- \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
- \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
- \fi
- \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup
- %
- % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
- % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
- \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
- \immediate\pdfimage
- \else
- \immediate\pdfximage
- \fi
- \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
- \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
- \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
- #1.\pdfimgext
- \else
- {#1.\pdfimgext}%
- \fi
- \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
- \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
- \fi}
- %
- \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
- % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
- % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \activebackslashdouble
- \makevalueexpandable
- \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
- \backslashparens\pdfdestname
- \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
- }}
- %
- % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
- \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
- %
- % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
- % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
- \def\urlcolor{\rgbDarkRed}
- \def\linkcolor{\rgbDarkRed}
- \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
- %
- % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
- % come from Petr Olsak
- \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
- \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
- \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
- \advance\tempnum by 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
- %
- % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
- % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
- % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
- % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
- % #4 is the page number
- %
- \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
- % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
- % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
- % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
- % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
- \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
- \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
- \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
- \else
- % Doubled backslashes in the name.
- {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
- \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
- \fi
- %
- % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
- {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
- \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
- %
- \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
- }
- %
- \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
- \begingroup
- % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
- \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
- \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
- %
- % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
- \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \def\thischapnum{##2}%
- \def\thissecnum{0}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
- }%
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
- \def\thissecnum{##2}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
- }%
- \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
- }%
- \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
- }%
- \def\thischapnum{0}%
- \def\thissecnum{0}%
- \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
- %
- % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
- % al. a second time, below.
- \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
- \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
- \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
- \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
- \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
- \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
- \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
- \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
- \readdatafile{toc}%
- %
- % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
- % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
- % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
- %
- % We use the node names as the destinations.
- \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
- \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
- \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
- %
- % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
- % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
- % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
- % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
- % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
- %
- % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
- % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
- % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
- \indexnofonts
- \setupdatafile
- \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
- \input \tocreadfilename
- \endgroup
- }
- %
- \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
- \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
- \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
- \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
- \advance\filenamelength by 1
- \fi
- \fi
- \nextsp}
- \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
- \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
- \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
- \else
- \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
- \fi
- % make a live url in pdf output.
- \def\pdfurl#1{%
- \begingroup
- % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
- % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
- % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
- % people have actually reported a problem with.
- %
- \normalturnoffactive
- \def\@{@}%
- \let\/=\empty
- \makevalueexpandable
- % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
- % special-casing \var here?
- \def\var##1{##1}%
- %
- \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
- \endgroup}
- \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
- \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
- \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
- \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
- \def\maketoks{%
- \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
- \ifx\first0\adn0
- \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
- \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
- \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
- \else
- \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
- \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
- \let\next=\maketoks
- \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
- \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \next}
- \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
- {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
- \def\pdflink#1{%
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
- \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
- \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
-\else
- % non-pdf mode
- \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
- \let\pdfurl = \gobble
- \let\endlink = \relax
- \let\setcolor = \gobble
- \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
- \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
-\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
-
-
-\message{fonts,}
-
-% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
-% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
-% italics, not bold italics.
-%
-\def\setfontstyle#1{%
- \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
- \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
-}
-
-% Select #1 fonts with the current style.
-%
-\def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
-
-\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
-\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
-\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
-\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
-\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
-
-% Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
-% in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
-\def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}}
-
-% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
-% So we set up a \sf.
-\newfam\sffam
-\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
-\let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
-
-% We don't need math for this font style.
-\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
-
-
-% Default leading.
-\newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
-
-% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
-% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
-% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
-%
-\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
-\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
-\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
-%
-% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
-\def\baselinefactor{1}
-%
-\def\setleading#1{%
- \dimen0 = #1\relax
- \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
- \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
- \normalbaselines
- \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
- \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
- depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
- }%
-}
-
-% PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
-%
-% do nothing with this by default.
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
-
-% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
-% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
-% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
-\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\undefined \else
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
- \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-8 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<23> <26> <0023>
-<28> <3B> <0028>
-<3F> <5B> <003F>
-<5D> <5E> <005D>
-<61> <7A> <0061>
-<7B> <7C> <2013>
-endbfrange
-40 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <00660066>
-<0C> <00660069>
-<0D> <0066006C>
-<0E> <006600660069>
-<0F> <00660066006C>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<21> <0021>
-<22> <201D>
-<27> <2019>
-<3C> <00A1>
-<3D> <003D>
-<3E> <00BF>
-<5C> <201C>
-<5F> <02D9>
-<60> <2018>
-<7D> <02DD>
-<7E> <007E>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
- }\endgroup
- \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
- \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
- }%
-%
-% \cmapOT1IT
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
- \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1IT)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-8 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<25> <26> <0025>
-<28> <3B> <0028>
-<3F> <5B> <003F>
-<5D> <5E> <005D>
-<61> <7A> <0061>
-<7B> <7C> <2013>
-endbfrange
-42 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <00660066>
-<0C> <00660069>
-<0D> <0066006C>
-<0E> <006600660069>
-<0F> <00660066006C>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<21> <0021>
-<22> <201D>
-<23> <0023>
-<24> <00A3>
-<27> <2019>
-<3C> <00A1>
-<3D> <003D>
-<3E> <00BF>
-<5C> <201C>
-<5F> <02D9>
-<60> <2018>
-<7D> <02DD>
-<7E> <007E>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
- }\endgroup
- \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
- \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
- }%
-%
-% \cmapOT1TT
- \begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
- \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1TT)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-5 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<21> <26> <0021>
-<28> <5F> <0028>
-<61> <7E> <0061>
-endbfrange
-32 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <2191>
-<0C> <2193>
-<0D> <0027>
-<0E> <00A1>
-<0F> <00BF>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<20> <2423>
-<27> <2019>
-<60> <2018>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
- }\endgroup
- \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
- \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
- }%
-\fi\fi
-
-
-% Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
-% specified font prefix (normally `cm').
-% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
-% encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
-% empty to omit).
-\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
- \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
-}
-% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
-\let\cmap\gobble
-% emacs-page end of cmaps
-
-% Use cm as the default font prefix.
-% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
-% before you read in texinfo.tex.
-\ifx\fontprefix\undefined
-\def\fontprefix{cm}
-\fi
-% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
-\def\rmshape{r}
-\def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
-\def\bfshape{b}
-\def\bxshape{bx}
-\def\ttshape{tt}
-\def\ttbshape{tt}
-\def\ttslshape{sltt}
-\def\itshape{ti}
-\def\itbshape{bxti}
-\def\slshape{sl}
-\def\slbshape{bxsl}
-\def\sfshape{ss}
-\def\sfbshape{ss}
-\def\scshape{csc}
-\def\scbshape{csc}
-
-% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
-% Texinfo.
-%
-\def\definetextfontsizexi{%
-% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
-\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
-\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\def\textecsize{1095}
-
-% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
-
-% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalli=cmmi9
-\font\smallsy=cmsy9
-\def\smallecsize{0900}
-
-% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
-\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalleri=cmmi8
-\font\smallersy=cmsy8
-\def\smallerecsize{0800}
-
-% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
-\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
-\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\titleecsize{2074}
-
-% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
-\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\chapbf=\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
-\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
-\def\chapecsize{1728}
-
-% Section fonts (14.4pt).
-\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
-\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-\def\sececsize{1440}
-
-% Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
-\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
-\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
-\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
-\def\ssececsize{1200}
-
-% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
-\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\font\reducedi=cmmi10
-\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
-\def\reducedecsize{1000}
-
-% reset the current fonts
-\textfonts
-\rm
-} % end of 11pt text font size definitions
-
-
-% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
-% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
-% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
-% future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
-%
-\def\definetextfontsizex{%
-% Text fonts (10pt).
-\def\textnominalsize{10pt}
-\edef\mainmagstep{1000}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\def\textecsize{1000}
-
-% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
-
-% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalli=cmmi9
-\font\smallsy=cmsy9
-\def\smallecsize{0900}
-
-% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
-\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalleri=cmmi8
-\font\smallersy=cmsy8
-\def\smallerecsize{0800}
-
-% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
-\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
-\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\titleecsize{2074}
-
-% Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
-\def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\chapbf\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
-\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-\def\chapecsize{1440}
-
-% Section fonts (12pt).
-\def\secnominalsize{12pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\font\seci=cmmi12
-\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
-\def\sececsize{1200}
-
-% Subsection fonts (10pt).
-\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\font\sseci=cmmi10
-\font\ssecsy=cmsy10
-\def\ssececsize{1000}
-
-% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
-\def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\reducedi=cmmi9
-\font\reducedsy=cmsy9
-\def\reducedecsize{0900}
-
-% reduce space between paragraphs
-\divide\parskip by 2
-
-% reset the current fonts
-\textfonts
-\rm
-} % end of 10pt text font size definitions
-
-
-% We provide the user-level command
-% @fonttextsize 10
-% (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
-%
-\def\xword{10}
-\def\xiword{11}
-%
-\parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
- \def\textsizearg{#1}%
- \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
- %
- % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
- % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
- %
- \begingroup \globaldefs=1
- \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
- \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
- \else
- \errhelp=\EMsimple
- \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
- \fi\fi
- \endgroup
-}
-
-
-% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
-% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
-% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
-% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
-% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
-%
-\def\resetmathfonts{%
- \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
- \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
- \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
-}
-
-% The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
-% of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
-% current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
-% \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
-%
-% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
-% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
-% the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
-%
-% This all needs generalizing, badly.
-%
-\def\textfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
- \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
- \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
- \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
- \def\curfontsize{text}%
- \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
-\def\titlefonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
- \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
- \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
- \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
- \def\curfontsize{title}%
- \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
-\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
-\def\chapfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
- \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
- \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
- \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
- \def\curfontsize{chap}%
- \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
-\def\secfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
- \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
- \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
- \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
- \def\curfontsize{sec}%
- \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
-\def\subsecfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
- \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
- \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
- \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
- \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
- \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
-\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
-\def\reducedfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
- \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
- \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
- \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
- \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
- \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
-\def\smallfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
- \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
- \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
- \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
- \def\curfontsize{small}%
- \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
-\def\smallerfonts{%
- \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
- \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
- \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
- \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
- \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
- \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
- \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
-
-% Fonts for short table of contents.
-\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
-\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
-
-% Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
-\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
-\def\angleright{$\rangle$}
-
-% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
-\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
-
-% About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
-% can fit this many characters:
-% 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
-% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
-% 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
-% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
-% the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
-%
-% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
-% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
-% --karl, 24jan03.
-
-% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
-%
-\definetextfontsizexi
-
-
-\message{markup,}
-
-% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
-% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
-% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
-% this property, we can check that font parameter.
-%
-\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
-
-% Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
-% define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
-% \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
-% style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
-% currently in effect.
-\newif\ifmarkupvar
-\newif\ifmarkupsamp
-\newif\ifmarkupkey
-%\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
-%\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
-\newif\ifmarkupcode
-\newif\ifmarkupkbd
-%\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
-%\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
-\newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
-\newif\ifmarkupexample
-\newif\ifmarkupverb
-\newif\ifmarkupverbatim
-
-\let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
-
-\def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
- \csname markup#1true\endcsname
- \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
- \markupstylesetup
-}
-
-\let\markupstylesetup\empty
-
-\def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
- \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
- \def#1%
-}
-
-% Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
-\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
- \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
-}
-
-\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
- \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
-}
-
-{
-\catcode`\'=\active
-\catcode`\`=\active
-
-\gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
-\gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
-
-\gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
-\gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
-
-\gdef\markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft{\let`\noligaturesquoteleft}
-}
-
-\let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
-\let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
-\let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
-\let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
-\let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
-
-\let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft
-\let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft
-
-% Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
-% quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
-% from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
-% the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
-% evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
-% regular 0x27.
-%
-\def\codequoteright{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
- '%
- \else \char'15 \fi
- \else \char'15 \fi
-}
-%
-% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
-% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
-% the code environments to do likewise.
-%
-\def\codequoteleft{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
- % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
- % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
- \relax`%
- \else \char'22 \fi
- \else \char'22 \fi
-}
-
-% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
-\def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
-
-% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
-\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
-
-%% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
-%% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
-
-% \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
-% unless the following character is such as not to need one.
-\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
- \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
-\def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-\def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
-% like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
-% @var is set to this for defun arguments.
-\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
-% @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
-% ttsl for book titles, do we?
-\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
-\let\i=\smartitalic
-\let\slanted=\smartslanted
-\def\var#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\smartslanted{#1}}}
-\let\dfn=\smartslanted
-\let\emph=\smartitalic
-
-% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
-\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
-\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
-\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
-
-% @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
-\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
-\let\strong=\b
-
-% @sansserif, explicit sans.
-\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
-
-% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
-% the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
-% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
-%
-\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
-\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
-
-% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
-% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
-% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
-%
-\catcode`@=11
- \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
- \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
- \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
- \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
- }
- \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
- \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
- \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
- \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
- }
-\catcode`@=\other
-\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
-
-% @t, explicit typewriter.
-\def\t#1{%
- {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
- \null
-}
-
-% @samp.
-\def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
-
-% definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
-%\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-%\font\keysy=cmsy9
-%\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
-% \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
-% \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
-% \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
-% \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
-% \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
-
-% definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
-% monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
-% if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
-%
-\def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
- \nohyphenation
- \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
- #1}\null}
-
-% ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command.
-\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
-
-% @file, @option are the same as @samp.
-\let\file=\samp
-\let\option=\samp
-
-% @code is a modification of @t,
-% which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
-\def\tclose#1{%
- {%
- % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
- \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
- %
- % Switch to typewriter.
- \tt
- %
- % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
- \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
- %
- % Turn off hyphenation.
- \nohyphenation
- %
- \rawbackslash
- \plainfrenchspacing
- #1%
- }%
- \null
-}
-
-% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
-% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
-% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
-
-% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
-% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
-% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
-% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
-% -- rms.
-{
- \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
- \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
- \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
- %
- \global\def\code{\begingroup
- \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
- % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
- \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
- \ifallowcodebreaks
- \let-\codedash
- \let_\codeunder
- \else
- \let-\realdash
- \let_\realunder
- \fi
- \codex
- }
-}
-
-\def\realdash{-}
-\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
-\def\codeunder{%
- % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
- % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
- % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
- % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
- \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
- \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
- \else\normalunderscore \fi
- \discretionary{}{}{}}%
- {\_}%
-}
-\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
-
-% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
-% each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
-% some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
-% general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
-%
-\newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
-
-\def\keywordtrue{true}
-\def\keywordfalse{false}
-
-\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
- \def\txiarg{#1}%
- \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
- \allowcodebreakstrue
- \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
- \allowcodebreaksfalse
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
- \fi\fi
-}
-
-% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
-% then @kbd has no effect.
-\def\kbd#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}}
-
-% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
-% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
-% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
-\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
- \def\txiarg{#1}%
- \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
- \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
- \else
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-\def\worddistinct{distinct}
-\def\wordexample{example}
-\def\wordcode{code}
-
-% Default is `distinct'.
-\kbdinputstyle distinct
-
-\def\xkey{\key}
-\def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
-\ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
-\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
-\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi}
-
-% For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
-\let\indicateurl=\code
-\let\env=\code
-\let\command=\code
-
-% @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
-\def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
-
-% @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
-\parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
-\def\click{\arrow}
-
-% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
-% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
-% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
-% itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
-% a hypertex \special here.
-%
-\def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
-\def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
- \unsepspaces
- \pdfurl{#1}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
- \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
- \else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
- \ifpdf
- \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
- \else
- \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
- \fi
- \else
- \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
- \fi
- \fi
- \endlink
-\endgroup}
-
-% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
-%
-\let\url=\uref
-
-% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
-% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
-%
-%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
-\ifpdf
- \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
- \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
- \unsepspaces
- \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
- \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
- \endlink
- \endgroup}
-\else
- \let\email=\uref
-\fi
-
-% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
-% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
-%
-\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
-
-% @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
-% and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
-% Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
-%\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
-
-% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
-% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
-% all-uppercase.
-%
-\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
-\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
- {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \else
- \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
- \fi
-}
-
-% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
-% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
-%
-\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
-\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
- {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \else
- \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
- \fi
-}
-
-
-\message{glyphs,}
-
-% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
-%
-% Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
-% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
-%
-\def\point{$\star$}
-\def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
-\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
-\def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
-\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
-\def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
-
-% The @error{} command.
-% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
-%
-\newbox\errorbox
-%
-{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
-\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
-% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
-\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
-%
-\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
- \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
- \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
- \vbox{%
- \hrule height\dimen2
- \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
- \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
- \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
- \hrule height\dimen2}
- \hfil}
-%
-\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
-
-% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
-%
-\def\pounds{{\it\$}}
-
-% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
-% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
-% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
-% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
-% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
-%
-% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
-% that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
-% font height.
-%
-% feymr - regular
-% feymo - slanted
-% feybr - bold
-% feybo - bold slanted
-%
-% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
-% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
-% Hmm.
-%
-% Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
-% Hope not.
-%
-%
-\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
-\def\eurofont{%
- % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
- % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
- % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
- % font installed.
- %
- % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
- % that to the current nominal size.
- %
- % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
- % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
- %
- \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
- %
- \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
- % bold:
- \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
- \else
- % regular:
- \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
- \fi
- \thiseurofont
-}
-
-% Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
-% sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
-% the redefinition.
-%
-% Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
-\def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
-\def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
-\def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
-\def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
-%
-\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
-\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
-\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
-\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
-\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
-\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
-\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
-\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
-%
-% This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
-% we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
-% tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
-% dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
-%
-% ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
-% the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
-% the same EC font.
-\def\ogonek#1{{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
- \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
- \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
- \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
- \else
- \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
- \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
- \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi
- }%
-}
-\def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
-\def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
-\def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
-\def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
-%
-% Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs.
-\def\ecfont{%
- % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
- % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
- % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
- % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
- \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
- \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
- \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
- % bold:
- \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
- \else
- % regular:
- \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
- \fi
- \thisecfont
-}
-
-% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
-% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
-% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
-%
-\def\registeredsymbol{%
- $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
- \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
- }$%
-}
-
-% @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
-%
-\def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
-
-% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
-% Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
-% so we'll define it if necessary.
-%
-\ifx\Orb\undefined
-\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
-\fi
-
-% Quotes.
-\chardef\quotedblleft="5C
-\chardef\quotedblright=`\"
-\chardef\quoteleft=`\`
-\chardef\quoteright=`\'
-
-
-\message{page headings,}
-
-\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
-\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
-
-% First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
-\newif\ifseenauthor
-\newif\iffinishedtitlepage
-
-% Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
-% user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
-%
-\newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
- \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
-\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
- \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
-
-\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
- \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
-
-\envdef\titlepage{%
- % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
- \begingroup
- \parindent=0pt \textfonts
- % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
- \vglue\titlepagetopglue
- % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
- \finishedtitlepagetrue
- %
- % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
- % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
- \let\oldpage = \page
- \def\page{%
- \iffinishedtitlepage\else
- \finishtitlepage
- \fi
- \let\page = \oldpage
- \page
- \null
- }%
-}
-
-\def\Etitlepage{%
- \iffinishedtitlepage\else
- \finishtitlepage
- \fi
- % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
- % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
- % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
- % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
- \oldpage
- \endgroup
- %
- % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
- % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
- \HEADINGSon
- %
- % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
- \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
- \shortcontents
- \contents
- \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
- \global\let\contents = \relax
- \fi
- %
- \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
- \contents
- \global\let\contents = \relax
- \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
- \fi
-}
-
-\def\finishtitlepage{%
- \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
- \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
- \finishedtitlepagetrue
-}
-
-%%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
-
-\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
-\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
-
-\parseargdef\title{%
- \checkenv\titlepage
- \leftline{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}
- % print a rule at the page bottom also.
- \finishedtitlepagefalse
- \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
-}
-
-\parseargdef\subtitle{%
- \checkenv\titlepage
- {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
-}
-
-% @author should come last, but may come many times.
-% It can also be used inside @quotation.
-%
-\parseargdef\author{%
- \def\temp{\quotation}%
- \ifx\thisenv\temp
- \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
- \else
- \checkenv\titlepage
- \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
- {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
- \fi
-}
-
-
-%%% Set up page headings and footings.
-
-\let\thispage=\folio
-
-\newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
-\newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
-\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
-\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
-
-% Now make TeX use those variables
-\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
- \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
-\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
- \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
-\let\HEADINGShook=\relax
-
-% Commands to set those variables.
-% For example, this is what @headings on does
-% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
-% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
-% @evenfooting @thisfile||
-% @oddfooting ||@thisfile
-
-
-\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
-\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
-\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
-\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
-\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
-
-\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
-\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
-\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
-
-\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
-\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
- \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
- %
- % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
- % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
- \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
- \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
-}
-
-\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
-
-% @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
-% @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
-%
-% The same set of arguments for:
-%
-% @oddheadingmarks
-% @evenfootingmarks
-% @oddfootingmarks
-% @everyheadingmarks
-% @everyfootingmarks
-
-\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
-\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
-\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
-\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
-\def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
- \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
-\def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
- \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
-% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
-\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
- \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
-}
-
-\everyheadingmarks bottom
-\everyfootingmarks bottom
-
-% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
-% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
-% @headings off turns them off.
-% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
-% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
-% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
-% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
-% By default, they are off at the start of a document,
-% and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
-
-\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
-
-\def\HEADINGSoff{%
-\global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
-\HEADINGSoff
-% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
-% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
-% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
-% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
-% edge of all pages.
-\def\HEADINGSdouble{%
-\global\pageno=1
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
-}
-\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-
-% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
-% page number on top right.
-\def\HEADINGSsingle{%
-\global\pageno=1
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-}
-\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
-
-\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
-\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
-\def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
-}
-
-\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
-\def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
-\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
-\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
-\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-}
-
-% Subroutines used in generating headings
-% This produces Day Month Year style of output.
-% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
-% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
-\ifx\today\undefined
-\def\today{%
- \number\day\space
- \ifcase\month
- \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
- \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
- \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
- \fi
- \space\number\year}
-\fi
-
-% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
-% It generates no output of its own.
-\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
-\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
-
-
-\message{tables,}
-% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
-
-% default indentation of table text
-\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
-% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
-\newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
-% margin between end of table item and start of table text.
-\newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
-
-% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
-\newdimen\itemmax
-
-% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
-% these defs.
-% They also define \itemindex
-% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
-
-\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
-
-\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
-
-\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
-\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
-
-\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
- \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
- \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
- \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
- \itemindex{#1}%
- \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
- %
- % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
- % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
- % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
- % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
- % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
- \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
- %
- % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
- % but leave it ragged-right.
- \begingroup
- \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
- \advance\hsize by\tableindent
- \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
- \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
- \endgroup
- %
- % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
- % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
- \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
- %
- % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
- % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
- % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
- % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
- % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
- % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
- %
- \penalty 10001
- \endgroup
- \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
- \else
- % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
- % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
- \noindent
- % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
- % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
- % eventually be printed.
- \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
- \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
- \unhbox0
- \nobreak\kern\dimen0
- \endgroup
- \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
- \fi
-}
-
-\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
-\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
-
-% @table, @ftable, @vtable.
-\envdef\table{%
- \let\itemindex\gobble
- \tablecheck{table}%
-}
-\envdef\ftable{%
- \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
- \tablecheck{ftable}%
-}
-\envdef\vtable{%
- \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
- \tablecheck{vtable}%
-}
-\def\tablecheck#1{%
- \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
- \endgroup
- \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
- that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
- \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
- \else
- \let\next\tablex
- \fi
- \next
-}
-\def\tablex#1{%
- \def\itemindicate{#1}%
- \parsearg\tabley
-}
-\def\tabley#1{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
- \expandafter
- }\temp \endtablez
-}
-\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
- \aboveenvbreak
- \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
- \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
- \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
- \itemmax=\tableindent
- \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
- \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
- \exdentamount=\tableindent
- \parindent = 0pt
- \parskip = \smallskipamount
- \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
- \let\item = \internalBitem
- \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
-}
-\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
-\let\Eftable\Etable
-\let\Evtable\Etable
-\let\Eitemize\Etable
-\let\Eenumerate\Etable
-
-% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
-
-\newcount \itemno
-
-\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
-
-\def\doitemize#1{%
- \aboveenvbreak
- \itemmax=\itemindent
- \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
- \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
- \exdentamount=\itemindent
- \parindent=0pt
- \parskip=\smallskipamount
- \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
- %
- % Try typesetting the item mark that if the document erroneously says
- % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
- % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
- % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
- % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
- \def\itemcontents{#1}%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
- %
- % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
- \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
- %
- \let\item=\itemizeitem
-}
-
-% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
-%
-\def\itemizeitem{%
- \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
- {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
- {%
- % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
- % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
- % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
- % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
- % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
- % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
- % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
- % that's the theory.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
- \noindent
- \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
- %
- \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
- \flushcr
-}
-
-% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
-% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
-%
-\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
-
-% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
-% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
-% argument is the same as `1'.
-%
-\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
-\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
- % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
- \def\thearg{#1}%
- \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
- %
- % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
- % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
- % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
- % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
- % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
- \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
- \ifx\rest\empty
- % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
- % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
- % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
- % not equal to itself.
- % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
- %
- % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
- % continuing to look for a <number>.
- %
- \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
- \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
- \else
- % It's a letter.
- \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
- \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
- \else
- \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
- \numericenumerate
- \fi
-}
-
-% An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
-% given in \thearg.
-%
-\def\numericenumerate{%
- \itemno = \thearg
- \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
-}
-
-% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
-\def\lowercaseenumerate{%
- \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
- \startenumeration{%
- % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
- \ifnum\itemno=0
- \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
- alphabet}%
- \fi
- \char\lccode\itemno
- }%
-}
-
-% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
-\def\uppercaseenumerate{%
- \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
- \startenumeration{%
- % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
- \ifnum\itemno=0
- \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
- alphabet}
- \fi
- \char\uccode\itemno
- }%
-}
-
-% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
-% common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
-% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
-%
-\def\startenumeration#1{%
- \advance\itemno by -1
- \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
-}
-
-% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
-% to @enumerate.
-%
-\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
-\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
-\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
-\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
-
-
-% @multitable macros
-% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
-%
-% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
-% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
-% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
-% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
-
-% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
-
-% To make preamble:
-%
-% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
-% @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
-% @item ...
-%
-% Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
-% current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
-% columns as desired.
-
-
-% Or use a template:
-% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
-% @item ...
-% using the widest term desired in each column.
-
-% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
-% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
-% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
-% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
-
-% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
-% if they are.
-
-% Sample multitable:
-
-% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
-% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
-% @item
-% first col stuff
-% @tab
-% second col stuff
-% @tab
-% third col
-% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
-% @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
-%
-% They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
-% @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
-% @end multitable
-
-% Default dimensions may be reset by user.
-% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
-% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
-% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
-% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
-% to baseline.
-% 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
-%
-\newskip\multitableparskip
-\newskip\multitableparindent
-\newdimen\multitablecolspace
-\newskip\multitablelinespace
-\multitableparskip=0pt
-\multitableparindent=6pt
-\multitablecolspace=12pt
-\multitablelinespace=0pt
-
-% Macros used to set up halign preamble:
-%
-\let\endsetuptable\relax
-\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
-\let\columnfractions\relax
-\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
-\newif\ifsetpercent
-
-% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
-% be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
-%
-\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
- \global\advance\colcount by 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
- \setuptable
-}
-
-\newcount\colcount
-\def\setuptable#1{%
- \def\firstarg{#1}%
- \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
- \let\go = \relax
- \else
- \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
- \global\setpercenttrue
- \else
- \ifsetpercent
- \let\go\pickupwholefraction
- \else
- \global\advance\colcount by 1
- \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
- % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
- \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
- % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
- % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
- \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
- \else
- \let\go = \setuptable
- \fi%
- \fi
- \go
-}
-
-% multitable-only commands.
-%
-% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
-% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
-% of an alignment entry. \everycr resets \everytab so we don't have to
-% undo it ourselves.
-\def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
-\def\headitem{%
- \checkenv\multitable
- \crcr
- \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
- \the\everytab % for the first item
-}%
-%
-% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
-% line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
-% we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
-% --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
-\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
-
-% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
-%
-\newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
-%
-\envdef\multitable{%
- \vskip\parskip
- \startsavinginserts
- %
- % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
- % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
- % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
- % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
- \def\item{\crcr}%
- %
- \tolerance=9500
- \hbadness=9500
- \setmultitablespacing
- \parskip=\multitableparskip
- \parindent=\multitableparindent
- \overfullrule=0pt
- \global\colcount=0
- %
- \everycr = {%
- \noalign{%
- \global\everytab={}%
- \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
- % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
- \checkinserts
- % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
- %\filbreak
- % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
- % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
- % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
- }%
- }%
- %
- \parsearg\domultitable
-}
-\def\domultitable#1{%
- % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
- \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
- %
- % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
- % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
- % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
- % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
- \halign\bgroup &%
- \global\advance\colcount by 1
- \multistrut
- \vtop{%
- % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
- \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
- %
- % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
- % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
- % the first one.
- %
- % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
- % to the width of each template entry.
- %
- % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
- % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
- % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
- % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
- %
- % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
- \rightskip=0pt
- \ifnum\colcount=1
- % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
- \advance\hsize by\leftskip
- \else
- \ifsetpercent \else
- % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
- % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
- \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
- \fi
- % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
- \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
- \fi
- % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
- % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
- % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
- % For example:
- % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
- % @item @code{#}
- % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
- % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
- % marking characters.
- \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
- }\cr
-}
-\def\Emultitable{%
- \crcr
- \egroup % end the \halign
- \global\setpercentfalse
-}
-
-\def\setmultitablespacing{%
- \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
- %
- % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
- % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
- % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
- % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
-\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
-\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
-\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
-\fi
-%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
-%% table. If not, do nothing.
-%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
-\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
-\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
-\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
- %% than skip between lines in the table.
-\fi%
-\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
-\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
-\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
- %% than skip between lines in the table.
-\fi}
-
-
-\message{conditionals,}
-
-% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
-% @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
-% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
-% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
-% attempt to close an environment group.
-%
-\def\makecond#1{%
- \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
- \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
-}
-\makecond{iftex}
-\makecond{ifnotdocbook}
-\makecond{ifnothtml}
-\makecond{ifnotinfo}
-\makecond{ifnotplaintext}
-\makecond{ifnotxml}
-
-% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
-%
-\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
-\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
-\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
-\def\html{\doignore{html}}
-\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
-\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
-\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
-\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
-\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
-\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
-\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
-\def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
-\def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
-
-% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
-%
-% A count to remember the depth of nesting.
-\newcount\doignorecount
-
-\def\doignore#1{\begingroup
- % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
- \obeylines
- \catcode`\@ = \other
- \catcode`\{ = \other
- \catcode`\} = \other
- %
- % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
- \spaceisspace
- %
- % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
- \doignorecount = 0
- %
- % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
- \dodoignore{#1}%
-}
-
-{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
- \obeylines %
- %
- \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
- % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
- %
- % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
- \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
- \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
- %
- % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
- % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
- % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
- \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
- %
- % And now expand that command.
- \doignoretext ^^M%
- }%
-}
-
-\def\doignoreyyy#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
- \let\next\doignoretextzzz
- \else % Found a nested condition, ...
- \advance\doignorecount by 1
- \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
- % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
- \fi
- \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
-}
-
-% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
-%
-\def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
- \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
- \let\next\enddoignore
- \else % Still inside a nested condition.
- \advance\doignorecount by -1
- \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
- \fi
- \next
-}
-
-% Finish off ignored text.
-{ \obeylines%
- % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
- % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
- % would result in a blank line in the output.
- \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
-}
-
-
-% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
-% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
-%
-% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
-% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
-% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
-% didn't need it.
-% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
-%
-\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
-\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \def\temp{#2}%
- \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
- \ifx\temp\empty
- \next{}%
- \else
- \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
- \fi
- }%
-}
-% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
-\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
-
-% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
-%
-\parseargdef\clear{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
- }%
-}
-
-% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
-\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
-\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
-{
- \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
- %
- \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
- \let\value = \expandablevalue
- % We don't want these characters active, ...
- \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
- % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
- % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
- % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
- \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
- }
-}
-
-% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
-% properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
-% The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
-% the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
-% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
-% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
-% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
-%
-\def\expandablevalue#1{%
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
- {[No value for ``#1'']}%
- \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
- \else
- \csname SET#1\endcsname
- \fi
-}
-
-% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
-% with @set.
-%
-% To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
-%
-\makecond{ifset}
-\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
-\def\doifset#1#2{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \let\next=\empty
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
- #1% If not set, redefine \next.
- \fi
- \expandafter
- }\next
-}
-\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
-
-% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
-% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
-%
-% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
-% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
-% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
-%
-\makecond{ifclear}
-\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
-\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
-
-% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
-% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
-\let\dircategory=\comment
-
-% @defininfoenclose.
-\let\definfoenclose=\comment
-
-
-\message{indexing,}
-% Index generation facilities
-
-% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
-% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
-\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
-
-% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
-% It automatically defines \fooindex such that
-% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
-% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
-% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
-% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
-% for the sake of vms.
-%
-\def\newindex#1{%
- \iflinks
- \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
- \fi
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
- \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
-}
-
-% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
-%
-\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
-
-% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
-%
-\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
-%
-\def\newcodeindex#1{%
- \iflinks
- \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
- \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
- \fi
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
-}
-
-
-% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
-% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
-%
-% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
-% inside @code.
-%
-\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
-\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
-
-% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
-% #3 the target index (bar).
-\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
- % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
- % closing the target index.
- \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax
- % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
- % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
- \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
- \fi
- % redefine \fooindfile:
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
- \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
- % redefine \fooindex:
- \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
-}
-
-% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
-% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
-% and it is "foo", the name of the index.
-
-% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
-% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
-
-% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
-% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
-
-\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
-\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
-
-% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
-\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
-\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
-
-% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
-% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
-% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
-%
-\def\indexdummies{%
- \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
- \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
- \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
- %
- % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
- % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
- % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
- \let\{ = \mylbrace
- \let\} = \myrbrace
- %
- % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
- % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
- % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
- % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
- % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
- % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
- % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
- % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
- % is still getting written without apparent harm.
- %
- % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
- % help-texinfo, 22may06):
- % @macro funindex {WORD}
- % @findex xyz
- % @end macro
- % ...
- % @funindex commtest
- %
- % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
- %
- % Sample whatsit resulting:
- % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
- %
- % So:
- \let\endinput = \empty
- %
- % Do the redefinitions.
- \commondummies
-}
-
-% For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
-% redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
-% \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
-% this will be simpler.
-%
-\def\atdummies{%
- \def\@{@@}%
- \def\ {@ }%
- \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
- \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
- %
- % Do the redefinitions.
- \commondummies
- \otherbackslash
-}
-
-% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
-%
-\def\commondummies{%
- %
- % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
- % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
- % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
- % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
- % from whatever follows.
- %
- % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
- % space.
- %
- % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
- % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
- % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
- %
- \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
- \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
- \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
- %
- \commondummiesnofonts
- %
- \definedummyletter\_%
- %
- % Non-English letters.
- \definedummyword\AA
- \definedummyword\AE
- \definedummyword\DH
- \definedummyword\L
- \definedummyword\O
- \definedummyword\OE
- \definedummyword\TH
- \definedummyword\aa
- \definedummyword\ae
- \definedummyword\dh
- \definedummyword\exclamdown
- \definedummyword\l
- \definedummyword\o
- \definedummyword\oe
- \definedummyword\ordf
- \definedummyword\ordm
- \definedummyword\questiondown
- \definedummyword\ss
- \definedummyword\th
- %
- % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
- \definedummyword\bf
- \definedummyword\gtr
- \definedummyword\hat
- \definedummyword\less
- \definedummyword\sf
- \definedummyword\sl
- \definedummyword\tclose
- \definedummyword\tt
- %
- \definedummyword\LaTeX
- \definedummyword\TeX
- %
- % Assorted special characters.
- \definedummyword\bullet
- \definedummyword\comma
- \definedummyword\copyright
- \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
- \definedummyword\dots
- \definedummyword\enddots
- \definedummyword\equiv
- \definedummyword\error
- \definedummyword\euro
- \definedummyword\guillemetleft
- \definedummyword\guillemetright
- \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
- \definedummyword\guilsinglright
- \definedummyword\expansion
- \definedummyword\minus
- \definedummyword\ogonek
- \definedummyword\pounds
- \definedummyword\point
- \definedummyword\print
- \definedummyword\quotedblbase
- \definedummyword\quotedblleft
- \definedummyword\quotedblright
- \definedummyword\quoteleft
- \definedummyword\quoteright
- \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
- \definedummyword\result
- \definedummyword\textdegree
- %
- % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
- \macrolist
- %
- \normalturnoffactive
- %
- % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
- % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
- \makevalueexpandable
-}
-
-% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
-%
-\def\commondummiesnofonts{%
- % Control letters and accents.
- \definedummyletter\!%
- \definedummyaccent\"%
- \definedummyaccent\'%
- \definedummyletter\*%
- \definedummyaccent\,%
- \definedummyletter\.%
- \definedummyletter\/%
- \definedummyletter\:%
- \definedummyaccent\=%
- \definedummyletter\?%
- \definedummyaccent\^%
- \definedummyaccent\`%
- \definedummyaccent\~%
- \definedummyword\u
- \definedummyword\v
- \definedummyword\H
- \definedummyword\dotaccent
- \definedummyword\ogonek
- \definedummyword\ringaccent
- \definedummyword\tieaccent
- \definedummyword\ubaraccent
- \definedummyword\udotaccent
- \definedummyword\dotless
- %
- % Texinfo font commands.
- \definedummyword\b
- \definedummyword\i
- \definedummyword\r
- \definedummyword\sc
- \definedummyword\t
- %
- % Commands that take arguments.
- \definedummyword\acronym
- \definedummyword\cite
- \definedummyword\code
- \definedummyword\command
- \definedummyword\dfn
- \definedummyword\email
- \definedummyword\emph
- \definedummyword\env
- \definedummyword\file
- \definedummyword\kbd
- \definedummyword\key
- \definedummyword\math
- \definedummyword\option
- \definedummyword\pxref
- \definedummyword\ref
- \definedummyword\samp
- \definedummyword\strong
- \definedummyword\tie
- \definedummyword\uref
- \definedummyword\url
- \definedummyword\var
- \definedummyword\verb
- \definedummyword\w
- \definedummyword\xref
-}
-
-% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
-% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
-% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
-% would be for a given command (usually its argument).
-%
-\def\indexnofonts{%
- % Accent commands should become @asis.
- \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
- % We can just ignore other control letters.
- \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
- % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
- \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
- %
- \commondummiesnofonts
- %
- % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
- % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
- % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
- %\let\tt=\asis
- %
- \def\ { }%
- \def\@{@}%
- % how to handle braces?
- \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
- %
- % Non-English letters.
- \def\AA{AA}%
- \def\AE{AE}%
- \def\DH{DZZ}%
- \def\L{L}%
- \def\OE{OE}%
- \def\O{O}%
- \def\TH{ZZZ}%
- \def\aa{aa}%
- \def\ae{ae}%
- \def\dh{dzz}%
- \def\exclamdown{!}%
- \def\l{l}%
- \def\oe{oe}%
- \def\ordf{a}%
- \def\ordm{o}%
- \def\o{o}%
- \def\questiondown{?}%
- \def\ss{ss}%
- \def\th{zzz}%
- %
- \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
- \def\TeX{TeX}%
- %
- % Assorted special characters.
- % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
- \def\bullet{bullet}%
- \def\comma{,}%
- \def\copyright{copyright}%
- \def\dots{...}%
- \def\enddots{...}%
- \def\equiv{==}%
- \def\error{error}%
- \def\euro{euro}%
- \def\expansion{==>}%
- \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
- \def\guillemetright{>>}%
- \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
- \def\guilsinglright{>}%
- \def\minus{-}%
- \def\point{.}%
- \def\pounds{pounds}%
- \def\print{-|}%
- \def\quotedblbase{"}%
- \def\quotedblleft{"}%
- \def\quotedblright{"}%
- \def\quoteleft{`}%
- \def\quoteright{'}%
- \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
- \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
- \def\result{=>}%
- \def\textdegree{o}%
- %
- % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
- % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
- % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
- % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
- % that starts with \.
- %
- % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
- % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
- % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
- %
- \macrolist
-}
-
-\let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
-\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
-
-% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
-% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
-\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
-
-% Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
-% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
-% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
-% is with most defuns, which call us directly).
-%
-\def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
- \iflinks
- {%
- % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
- \toks0 = {#2}%
- % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
- \def\thirdarg{#3}%
- \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
- \fi
- %
- \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
- %
- \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
- }%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
-%
-\def\dosubindwrite{%
- % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
- \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
- \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
- \fi
- %
- % Remember, we are within a group.
- \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
- \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
- % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
- %
- % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
- % get the string to sort by.
- {\indexnofonts
- \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
- \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
- }%
- %
- % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
- % the original text, including any font commands. We write
- % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
- % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
- % sorted result.
- \edef\temp{%
- \write\writeto{%
- \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
- }%
- \temp
-}
-
-% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
-%
-% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
-% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
-% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
-% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
-% sequences like this:
-% @end defun
-% @tindex whatever
-% @defun ...
-% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
-% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
-% the previous defun.
-%
-% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
-% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
-%
-% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
-%
-% But wait, there is a catch there:
-% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
-% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
-% of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
-% representation of the skip.
-%
-% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
-% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
-%
-\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
-%
-\newskip\whatsitskip
-\newcount\whatsitpenalty
-%
-% ..., ready, GO:
-%
-\def\safewhatsit#1{%
-\ifhmode
- #1%
-\else
- % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
- \whatsitskip = \lastskip
- \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
- \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
- %
- % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
- % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
- % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
- % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
- % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
- \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
- \else
- \vskip-\whatsitskip
- \fi
- %
- #1%
- %
- \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
- % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
- % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
- % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
- % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
- % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
- %
- % @deffn deffn-whatever
- % @vindex index-whatever
- % Description.
- % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
- % and the "Description." paragraph.
- \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
- \else
- % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
- % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
- % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
- \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
- \fi
-\fi
-}
-
-% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
-% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
-% or
-% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
-% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
-% containing these kinds of lines:
-% \initial {c}
-% before the first topic whose initial is c
-% \entry {topic}{pagelist}
-% for a topic that is used without subtopics
-% \primary {topic}
-% for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
-% \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
-% for each subtopic.
-
-% Define the user-accessible indexing commands
-% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
-
-\def\findex {\fnindex}
-\def\kindex {\kyindex}
-\def\cindex {\cpindex}
-\def\vindex {\vrindex}
-\def\tindex {\tpindex}
-\def\pindex {\pgindex}
-
-\def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
-{\obeylines %
-\gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
-\dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
-
-% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
-
-% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
-% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
-%
-\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
- \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
- %
- \smallfonts \rm
- \tolerance = 9500
- \plainfrenchspacing
- \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
- %
- % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
- % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
- % \initial {@}
- % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
- % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
- \catcode`\@ = 11
- \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
- \ifeof 1
- % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
- % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
- % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
- % there is some text.
- \putwordIndexNonexistent
- \else
- %
- % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
- % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
- % it can discover if there is anything in it.
- \read 1 to \temp
- \ifeof 1
- \putwordIndexIsEmpty
- \else
- % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
- % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
- % to make right now.
- \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
- \catcode`\\ = 0
- \escapechar = `\\
- \begindoublecolumns
- \input \jobname.#1s
- \enddoublecolumns
- \fi
- \fi
- \closein 1
-\endgroup}
-
-% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
-% Change them to control the appearance of the index.
-
-\def\initial#1{{%
- % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
- \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
- %
- % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
- \removelastskip
- %
- % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
- \nobreak
- \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
- \penalty 0
- \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
- %
- % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
- % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
- % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
- % we need before each entry, but it's better.
- %
- % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
- \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
- \leftline{\secbf #1}%
- % Do our best not to break after the initial.
- \nobreak
- \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
-}}
-
-% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
-% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
-% and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
-%
-% A straightforward implementation would start like this:
-% \def\entry#1#2{...
-% But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
-% @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
-% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
-%
-% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
-% --kasal, 21nov03
-\def\entry{%
- \begingroup
- %
- % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
- % affect previous text.
- \par
- %
- % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
- \parfillskip = 0in
- %
- % No extra space above this paragraph.
- \parskip = 0in
- %
- % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
- \finalhyphendemerits = 0
- %
- % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
- % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
- % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
- % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
- % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
- %
- % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
- % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
- \hangindent = 2em
- %
- % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
- % with blank space.
- \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
- %
- % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
- % columns.
- \vskip 0pt plus1pt
- %
- % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
- \afterassignment\doentry
- \let\temp =
-}
-\def\doentry{%
- \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
- \noindent
- \aftergroup\finishentry
- % And now comes the text of the entry.
-}
-\def\finishentry#1{%
- % #1 is the page number.
- %
- % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
- % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
- % cursed by a Unix daemon.
- \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
- \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
- \ %
- \else
- %
- % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
- % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
- % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
- \hfil\penalty50
- \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
- %
- % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
- % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
- % \hbox ensues.
- \ifpdf
- \pdfgettoks#1.%
- \ \the\toksA
- \else
- \ #1%
- \fi
- \fi
- \par
- \endgroup
-}
-
-% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
-\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
- \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
-
-\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
-
-\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
-\def\secondary#1#2{{%
- \parfillskip=0in
- \parskip=0in
- \hangindent=1in
- \hangafter=1
- \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
- \ifpdf
- \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
- \else
- #2
- \fi
- \par
-}}
-
-% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
-% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
-% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
-\catcode`\@=11
-
-\newbox\partialpage
-\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
-
-\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
- % Grab any single-column material above us.
- \output = {%
- %
- % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
- % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
- % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
- % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
- % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
- % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
- % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
- \ifvoid\partialpage \else
- \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
- \fi
- %
- \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
- % Unvbox the main output page.
- \unvbox\PAGE
- \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
- }%
- }%
- \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
- %
- % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
- \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
- %
- % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
- % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
- % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
- % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
- % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
- %
- % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
- % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
- % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
- % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
- % as it did when we hard-coded it.
- %
- % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
- % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
- % been clobbered.
- %
- \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
- \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
- \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
- \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
- %
- % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
- % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
- \vsize = 2\vsize
-}
-
-% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
-% the last.
-%
-\def\doublecolumnout{%
- \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
- % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
- % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
- % previous page.
- \dimen@ = \vsize
- \divide\dimen@ by 2
- \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
- %
- % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
- \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
- \onepageout\pagesofar
- \unvbox255
- \penalty\outputpenalty
-}
-%
-% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
-% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
-\def\pagesofar{%
- \unvbox\partialpage
- %
- \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
- \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
- \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
-}
-%
-% All done with double columns.
-\def\enddoublecolumns{%
- % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
- % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
- % following situation:
- %
- % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
- % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
- % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
- % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
- % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
- % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
- % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
- % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
- % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
- % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
- % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
- % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
- % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
- % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
- % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
- % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
- % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
- % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
- % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
- %
- % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
- % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
- \penalty0
- %
- \output = {%
- % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
- % current page, no automatic page break.
- \balancecolumns
- %
- % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
- % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
- % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
- % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
- % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
- % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
- % the output somewhat more palatable.)
- \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
- }%
- \eject
- \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
- %
- % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
- % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
- % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
- % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
- \pagegoal = \vsize
-}
-%
-% Called at the end of the double column material.
-\def\balancecolumns{%
- \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
- \dimen@ = \ht0
- \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
- \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
- \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
- %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
- \splittopskip = \topskip
- % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
- {%
- \vbadness = 10000
- \loop
- \global\setbox3 = \copy0
- \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
- \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
- \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
- \repeat
- }%
- %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
- \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
- \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
- %
- \pagesofar
-}
-\catcode`\@ = \other
-
-
-\message{sectioning,}
-% Chapters, sections, etc.
-
-% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
-% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
-% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
-% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
-% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
-\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
-\newcount\chapno
-\newcount\secno \secno=0
-\newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
-\newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
-
-% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
-\newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
-%
-% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
-% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
-% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
-% letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
-%
-\def\appendixletter{%
- \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
- \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
- % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
- % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
- % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
- % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
- \else\char\the\appendixno
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
- \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
-
-% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
-% and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
-% these. @section does likewise.
-\def\thischapter{}
-\def\thischapternum{}
-\def\thischaptername{}
-\def\thissection{}
-\def\thissectionnum{}
-\def\thissectionname{}
-
-\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
-\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
-
-% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
-\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
-\let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
-
-% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
-\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
-\let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
-
-% we only have subsub.
-\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
-%
-% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
-% To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
-\chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
-%
-% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
-% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
-\def\chapheadtype{N}
-
-% Choose a heading macro
-% #1 is heading type
-% #2 is heading level
-% #3 is text for heading
-\def\genhead#1#2#3{%
- % Compute the abs. sec. level:
- \absseclevel=#2
- \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
- % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
- \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
- \absseclevel = 0
- \else
- \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
- \absseclevel = 3
- \fi
- \fi
- % The heading type:
- \def\headtype{#1}%
- \if \headtype U%
- \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
- \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
- \fi
- \else
- % Check for appendix sections:
- \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
- \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
- \else
- \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
- \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
- \fi\fi
- \fi
- % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
- \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
- \def\headtype{U}%
- \else
- \chardef\unmlevel = 3
- \fi
- \fi
- % Now print the heading:
- \if \headtype U%
- \ifcase\absseclevel
- \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
- \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
- \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
- \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
- \fi
- \else
- \if \headtype A%
- \ifcase\absseclevel
- \appendixzzz{#3}%
- \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
- \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
- \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
- \fi
- \else
- \ifcase\absseclevel
- \chapterzzz{#3}%
- \or \seczzz{#3}%
- \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
- \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% an interface:
-\def\numhead{\genhead N}
-\def\apphead{\genhead A}
-\def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
-
-% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
-% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
-%
-% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
-% (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
-\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
-%
-\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
-\def\chapterzzz#1{%
- % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
- % as an @include file.
- \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
- \global\advance\chapno by 1
- %
- % Used for \float.
- \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
- \resetallfloatnos
- %
- % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
- \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
- \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
- %
- % Write the actual heading.
- \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
- %
- % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
- \global\let\section = \numberedsec
- \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
- \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
-%
-\def\appendixzzz#1{%
- \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
- \global\advance\appendixno by 1
- \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
- \resetallfloatnos
- %
- % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
- \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
- \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
- %
- \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
- %
- \global\let\section = \appendixsec
- \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
- \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
-\def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
- \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
- \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
- %
- % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
- \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
- \resetallfloatnos
- %
- % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
- % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
- % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
- % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
- % to be executed, not expanded).
- %
- % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
- % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
- % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
- % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
- % the toc entries.)
- \toks0 = {#1}%
- \message{(\the\toks0)}%
- %
- \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
- %
- \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
- \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
- \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
-}
-
-% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
-\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
- % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
- % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
- % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
- \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
- \unnmhead0{#1}%
- \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-}
-
-% @top is like @unnumbered.
-\let\top\unnumbered
-
-% Sections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
-\def\seczzz#1{%
- \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
-\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
- \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
-}
-\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
-
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
-\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
-}
-
-% Subsections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
-\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
-\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
- {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
-\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
- {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
-}
-
-% Subsubsections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
-\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
- {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
-\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
- {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
-}
-
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
-\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
- \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
- \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
- {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
-}
-
-% These macros control what the section commands do, according
-% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
-% Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
-\let\section = \numberedsec
-\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
-\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
-
-% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
-
-% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
-% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
-% overlong headings to fold.
-% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
-% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
-% 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
-% if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
-
-\def\majorheading{%
- {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
- \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
-}
-
-\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
-\def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
- {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt\ptexraggedright
- \rmisbold #1\hfill}}%
- \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
-\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
- \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-
-% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
-% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
-% given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
-
-%%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
-\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
-
-%%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
-% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
-
-\newskip\chapheadingskip
-
-\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
-\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
-% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
-% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
-% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
-\def\chapoddpage{%
- \chappager
- \ifodd\pageno \else
- \begingroup
- \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
- \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
- \hbox to 0pt{}%
- \chappager
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
-
-\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
-
-\def\CHAPPAGoff{%
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
-\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
-
-\def\CHAPPAGon{%
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
-\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
-\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
-\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
-
-\def\CHAPPAGodd{%
-\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
-\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
-\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
-\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
-
-\CHAPPAGon
-
-% Chapter opening.
-%
-% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
-% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
-%
-% To test against our argument.
-\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
-\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
-\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
-%
-\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
- % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
- \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
- \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
- \gdef\thissection{}}%
- %
- \def\temptype{#2}%
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
- \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
- \gdef\thischapter{}}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
- % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
- \noexpand\thischapternum:
- \noexpand\thischaptername}%
- }%
- \else
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
- % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
- \noexpand\thischapternum:
- \noexpand\thischaptername}%
- }%
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
- % the preceding space.
- \safewhatsit\domark
- %
- % Insert the chapter heading break.
- \pchapsepmacro
- %
- % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
- % between here and the heading.
- \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
- \domark
- %
- {%
- \chapfonts \rmisbold
- %
- % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
- % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
- % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
- \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
- %
- % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
- % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
- \def\toctype{unnchap}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
- \def\toctype{omit}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{app}%
- \else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{numchap}%
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
- % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
- % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
- \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
- %
- % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
- % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
- % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
- % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
- % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
- \donoderef{#2}%
- %
- % Typeset the actual heading.
- \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
- \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
- \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
- \unhbox0 #1\par}%
- }%
- \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
- \nobreak
-}
-
-% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
-\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-\def\centerparameters{%
- \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
- \leftskip = \rightskip
- \parfillskip = 0pt
-}
-
-
-% I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
-% updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
-%
-\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
-%
-\def\unnchfopen #1{%
-\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt\ptexraggedright
- \rmisbold #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
-}
-\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
-\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
-\par\penalty 5000 %
-}
-\def\centerchfopen #1{%
-\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
- \parindent=0pt
- \hfill {\rmisbold #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
-}
-\def\CHAPFopen{%
- \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
- \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
-
-
-% Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
-% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
-%
-\newskip\secheadingskip
-\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
-
-% Subsection titles.
-\newskip\subsecheadingskip
-\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
-
-% Subsubsection titles.
-\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
-\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
-
-
-% Print any size, any type, section title.
-%
-% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
-% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
-% section number.
-%
-\def\seckeyword{sec}
-%
-\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
- {%
- % Switch to the right set of fonts.
- \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold
- %
- \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
- \def\temptype{#3}%
- %
- % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
- \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
- \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
- \fi
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- % Don't redefine \thissection.
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
- % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
- \noexpand\thissectionnum:
- \noexpand\thissectionname}%
- }%
- \fi
- \else
- \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
- \toks0={#1}%
- \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
- \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
- % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
- % commands in some of the translations.
- \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
- \noexpand\thissectionnum:
- \noexpand\thissectionname}%
- }%
- \fi
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
- % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
- % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
- \par
- %
- % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
- % the preceding space.
- \safewhatsit\domark
- %
- % Insert space above the heading.
- \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
- %
- % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
- % between here and the heading.
- \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
- \domark
- %
- % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
- \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
- \def\toctype{unn}%
- \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
- % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
- % and don't redefine \lastsection.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
- \def\toctype{omit}%
- \let\sectionlevel=\empty
- \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{app}%
- \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
- \else
- \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
- \def\toctype{num}%
- \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
- \fi\fi\fi
- %
- % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
- \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
- %
- % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
- % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
- \donoderef{#3}%
- %
- % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
- % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
- % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
- % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
- % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
- % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
- \nobreak
- %
- % Output the actual section heading.
- \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
- \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
- \unhbox0 #1}%
- }%
- % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
- % Don't allow stretch, though.
- \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
- %
- % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
- % was followed by glue.
- \nobreak
- %
- % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
- % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
- % discardable item.)
- \vskip-\parskip
- %
- % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
- % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
- % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
- %
- % @section sec-whatever
- % @deffn def-whatever
- \penalty 10001
-}
-
-
-\message{toc,}
-% Table of contents.
-\newwrite\tocfile
-
-% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
-% Called from @chapter, etc.
-%
-% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
-% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
-% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
-% read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
-% destination to jump to.
-%
-% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
-% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
-% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
-% table of contents chapter openings themselves.
-%
-\newif\iftocfileopened
-\def\omitkeyword{omit}%
-%
-\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
- \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
- \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
- \iftocfileopened\else
- \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
- \global\tocfileopenedtrue
- \fi
- %
- \iflinks
- {\atdummies
- \edef\temp{%
- \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
- \temp
- }%
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
- % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
- % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
- % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
- % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
- % `1', and two named `2'.
- \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
-}
-
-
-% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
-% fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
-% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
-%
-\def\activecatcodes{%
- \catcode`\"=\active
- \catcode`\$=\active
- \catcode`\<=\active
- \catcode`\>=\active
- \catcode`\\=\active
- \catcode`\^=\active
- \catcode`\_=\active
- \catcode`\|=\active
- \catcode`\~=\active
-}
-
-
-% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
-\def\readtocfile{%
- \setupdatafile
- \activecatcodes
- \input \tocreadfilename
-}
-
-\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
-\newcount\savepageno
-\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
-
-% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
-%
-\def\startcontents#1{%
- % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
- % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
- % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
- % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
- \contentsalignmacro
- \immediate\closeout\tocfile
- %
- % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
- % It is abundantly clear what they are.
- \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
- %
- \savepageno = \pageno
- \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
- \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
- \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
- %
- % Roman numerals for page numbers.
- \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
-}
-
-% redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
-% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
-%
-\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
-
-% Normal (long) toc.
-%
-\def\contents{%
- \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
- \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \readtocfile
- \fi
- \vfill \eject
- \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \pdfmakeoutlines
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup
- \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
- \global\pageno = \savepageno
-}
-
-% And just the chapters.
-\def\summarycontents{%
- \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
- %
- \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
- \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
- \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
- % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
- \secfonts
- \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
- \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
- \rm
- \hyphenpenalty = 10000
- \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
- \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
- \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
- \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \readtocfile
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \vfill \eject
- \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
- \endgroup
- \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
- \global\pageno = \savepageno
-}
-\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
-
-% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
-% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
-%
-\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
- % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
- % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
- % But use \hss just in case.
- % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
- % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
- %
- % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
- % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
- % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
- % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
- % there are before deciding ...
- \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
-}
-
-% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
-% The first argument is the chapter or section name.
-% The last argument is the page number.
-% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
-
-% Chapters, in the main contents.
-\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-%
-% Chapters, in the short toc.
-% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
-\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
- \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
-}
-
-% Appendices, in the main contents.
-% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
-%
-\def\appendixbox#1{%
- % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
- \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
-%
-\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-
-% Unnumbered chapters.
-\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
-\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
-
-% Sections.
-\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
-\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
-
-% Subsections.
-\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
-\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
-
-% And subsubsections.
-\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
-\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
-\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
-
-% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
-% Same as \defaultparindent.
-\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
-
-% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
-% page number.
-%
-% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
-% if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
-\def\dochapentry#1#2{%
- \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
- \begingroup
- \chapentryfonts
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
- \endgroup
- \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
-}
-
-\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
-\endgroup}
-
-\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
-\endgroup}
-
-\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
- \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
- \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
-\endgroup}
-
-% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
-\let\tocentry = \entry
-
-% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
-\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
-
-\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
-\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
-
-\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
-\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
-\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
-\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
-
-
-\message{environments,}
-% @foo ... @end foo.
-
-% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
-% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
-% But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
-
-\envdef\tex{%
- \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
- \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
- \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
- \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
- \catcode `\%=14
- \catcode `\+=\other
- \catcode `\"=\other
- \catcode `\|=\other
- \catcode `\<=\other
- \catcode `\>=\other
- \catcode`\`=\other
- \catcode`\'=\other
- \escapechar=`\\
- %
- \let\b=\ptexb
- \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
- \let\c=\ptexc
- \let\,=\ptexcomma
- \let\.=\ptexdot
- \let\dots=\ptexdots
- \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
- \let\!=\ptexexclam
- \let\i=\ptexi
- \let\indent=\ptexindent
- \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
- \let\{=\ptexlbrace
- \let\+=\tabalign
- \let\}=\ptexrbrace
- \let\/=\ptexslash
- \let\*=\ptexstar
- \let\t=\ptext
- \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % outer
- \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
- %
- \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
- \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
- \def\@{@}%
-}
-% There is no need to define \Etex.
-
-% Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
-% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
-% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
-
-% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
-\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
-
-% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
-% such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
-% have any width.
-\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
-
-% This space is always present above and below environments.
-\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
-
-% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
-% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
-% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
-% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
-%
-\def\aboveenvbreak{{%
- % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
- % \sectionheading, q.v.
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
- \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
- \endgraf
- \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
- \removelastskip
- % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
- % or better ...
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
- \vskip\envskipamount
- \fi
- \fi
-}}
-
-\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
-
-% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
-% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
-\let\nonarrowing=\relax
-
-% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
-% environment contents.
-\font\circle=lcircle10
-\newdimen\circthick
-\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
-\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
-\circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
-%
-\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
-\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
-\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
-\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
-\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
- \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
- \hskip\rskip}}
-\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
- \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
- \hskip\rskip}}
-%
-\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
-
-\envdef\cartouche{%
- \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
- \startsavinginserts
- \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
- \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
- \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
- \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
- \cartouter=\hsize
- \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
- % side, and for 6pt waste from
- % each corner char, and rule thickness
- \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
- % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \vbox\bgroup
- \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
- \carttop
- \hbox\bgroup
- \hskip\lskip
- \vrule\kern3pt
- \vbox\bgroup
- \kern3pt
- \hsize=\cartinner
- \baselineskip=\normbskip
- \lineskip=\normlskip
- \parskip=\normpskip
- \vskip -\parskip
- \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
-}
-\def\Ecartouche{%
- \ifhmode\par\fi
- \kern3pt
- \egroup
- \kern3pt\vrule
- \hskip\rskip
- \egroup
- \cartbot
- \egroup
- \checkinserts
-}
-
-
-% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
-% inside a group.
-\newdimen\nonfillparindent
-\def\nonfillstart{%
- \aboveenvbreak
- \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
- \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
- \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
- \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
- \parskip = 0pt
- % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
- % the normal \indent.
- \nonfillparindent=\parindent
- \parindent = 0pt
- \let\indent\nonfillindent
- %
- \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
- \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
- \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
- \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
- \else
- \let\nonarrowing = \relax
- \fi
- \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
-}
-
-\begingroup
-\obeyspaces
-% We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
-% @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
-% active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
-% @indent.
-\gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
-\gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
-\ifx\temp %
-\expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
-\else%
-\leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
-\fi%
-}%
-\endgroup
-\def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
-\def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
-
-% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
-% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
-% This affects the following displayed environments:
-% @example, @display, @format, @lisp
-%
-\def\smallword{small}
-\def\nosmallword{nosmall}
-\let\SETdispenvsize\relax
-\def\setnormaldispenv{%
- \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
- % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
- % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
- % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
- % to change the fonts afterward.
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
- \smallexamplefonts \rm
- \fi
-}
-\def\setsmalldispenv{%
- \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
- \else
- \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
- \smallexamplefonts \rm
- \fi
-}
-
-% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
-% Let's do it by one command:
-\def\makedispenv #1#2{
- \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
- \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
- \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
- \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
-}
-
-% Define two synonyms:
-\def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
- \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
- \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
-}
-
-% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
-%
-% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
-% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
-%
-\maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
- \nonfillstart
- \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
- \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
- \gobble % eat return
-}
-% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
-%
-\makedispenv {display}{%
- \nonfillstart
- \gobble
-}
-
-% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
-%
-\makedispenv{format}{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \gobble
-}
-
-% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
-\envdef\flushleft{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \gobble
-}
-\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
-
-% @flushright.
-%
-\envdef\flushright{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
- \gobble
-}
-\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
-
-
-% @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
-% justification. From plain.tex.
-\envdef\raggedright{%
- \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
-}
-\let\Eraggedright\par
-
-\envdef\raggedleft{%
- \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
- \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
- \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
- % badness reporting.
-}
-\let\Eraggedleft\par
-
-\envdef\raggedcenter{%
- \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
- \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
- \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
- % badness reporting.
-}
-\let\Eraggedcenter\par
-
-
-% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
-% and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
-% we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
-% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
-%
-\def\quotationstart{%
- {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
- \parindent=0pt
- %
- % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
- \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
- \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
- \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
- \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
- \else
- \let\nonarrowing = \relax
- \fi
- \parsearg\quotationlabel
-}
-
-\envdef\quotation{%
- \setnormaldispenv
- \quotationstart
-}
-
-\envdef\smallquotation{%
- \setsmalldispenv
- \quotationstart
-}
-\let\Esmallquotation = \Equotation
-
-% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
-% doing normal filling.
-%
-\def\Equotation{%
- \par
- \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
- % indent a bit.
- \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
- \fi
- {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
-}
-
-% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
-\def\quotationlabel#1{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \ifx\temp\empty \else
- {\bf #1: }%
- \fi
-}
-
-
-% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
-% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
-% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
-% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
-%
-% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
-%
-% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
-% active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
-% verbatim line.
-\def\dospecials{%
- \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
- \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
- \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
- % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
- % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
- % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
- %\do\`\do\'%
-}
-%
-% [Knuth] p. 380
-\def\uncatcodespecials{%
- \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
-%
-% Setup for the @verb command.
-%
-% Eight spaces for a tab
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^I=\active
- \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
-\endgroup
-%
-\def\setupverb{%
- \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
- \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
- \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
- \tabeightspaces
- % Respect line breaks,
- % print special symbols as themselves, and
- % make each space count
- % must do in this order:
- \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
-}
-
-% Setup for the @verbatim environment
-%
-% Real tab expansion
-\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
-%
-\def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
-%
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^I=\active
- \gdef\tabexpand{%
- \catcode`\^^I=\active
- \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
- \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
- \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
- \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
- \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
- \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
- }%
- }
-\endgroup
-
-% start the verbatim environment.
-\def\setupverbatim{%
- \let\nonarrowing = t%
- \nonfillstart
- % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
- \tt
- \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
- \tabexpand
- \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
- % Respect line breaks,
- % print special symbols as themselves, and
- % make each space count
- % must do in this order:
- \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
- \everypar{\starttabbox}%
-}
-
-% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
-% delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
-% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
-%
-% \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
-%
-% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
-\begingroup
- \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
- \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
-\endgroup
-%
-\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
-%
-%
-% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
-% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
-%
-% \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
-%
-% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
-% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
-% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
-%
-% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
-%
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\ =\active
- \obeylines %
- % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
- % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
- % line in the output.
- \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
- % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
- % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
-\endgroup
-%
-\envdef\verbatim{%
- \setupverbatim\doverbatim
-}
-\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
-
-
-% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
-%
-\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
-%
-\def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
- {%
- \makevalueexpandable
- \setupverbatim
- \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
- \input #1
- \afterenvbreak
- }%
-}
-
-% @copying ... @end copying.
-% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
-%
-% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
-% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
-% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
-% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
-% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
-% possible is very desirable.
-%
-\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
-\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
-%
-\def\insertcopying{%
- \begingroup
- \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
- \scanexp\copyingtext
- \endgroup
-}
-
-
-\message{defuns,}
-% @defun etc.
-
-\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
-\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
-\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
-\newcount\defunpenalty
-
-% Start the processing of @deffn:
-\def\startdefun{%
- \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
- \medbreak
- \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
- % following @def command, see below.
- \else
- % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
- % which is there to keep the function description together with its
- % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
- % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
- % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
- % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
- % a break between a section heading and a defun.
- %
- % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
- % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
- % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
- % @def command.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
- %
- % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
- % But do insert the glue.
- \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
- \fi
- %
- \parindent=0in
- \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-}
-
-\def\dodefunx#1{%
- % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
- \checkenv#1%
- %
- % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
- % It's not a great place, though.
- \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
- %
- % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
- \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
-}
-\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
-
-% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
-%
-\def\printdefunline#1#2{%
- \begingroup
- % call \deffnheader:
- #1#2 \endheader
- % common ending:
- \interlinepenalty = 10000
- \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
- \endgraf
- \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
- \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
- % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
- % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
- \checkparencounts
- \endgroup
-}
-
-\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
-
-% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
-% the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
-%
-\def\makedefun#1{%
- \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
- \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
- \temp
-}
-
-% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
-%
-% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
-% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
-%
-\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
- \envdef#1{%
- \startdefun
- \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
- }%
- \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
- \def#3%
-}
-
-%%% Untyped functions:
-
-% @deffn category name args
-\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
-
-% @deffn category class name args
-\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
-
-% \defopon {category on}class name args
-\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
-
-% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
-%
-\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
- % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
- \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
-}
-
-%%% Typed functions:
-
-% @deftypefn category type name args
-\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
-
-% @deftypeop category class type name args
-\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
-
-% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
-\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
-
-% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
-%
-\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
- \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
- \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
-}
-
-%%% Typed variables:
-
-% @deftypevr category type var args
-\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
-
-% @deftypecv category class type var args
-\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
-
-% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
-\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
-
-% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
-%
-\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
- \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
- \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
-}
-
-%%% Untyped variables:
-
-% @defvr category var args
-\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
-
-% @defcv category class var args
-\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
-
-% \defcvof {category of}class var args
-\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
-
-%%% Type:
-% @deftp category name args
-\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
- \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
- \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
-}
-
-% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
-\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
-\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
-\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
-\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
-\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
-\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
-\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
-\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
-\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
-\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
-\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
-
-% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
-% #1 is the category, such as "Function".
-% #2 is the return type, if any.
-% #3 is the function name.
-%
-% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
-%
-\def\defname#1#2#3{%
- % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
- \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
- %
- % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
- % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
- % just below it.
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
- %
- % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
- % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
- % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
- \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
- % The continuations:
- \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
- % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
- \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
- %
- % Put the type name to the right margin.
- \noindent
- \hbox to 0pt{%
- \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
- % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
- \kern\leftskip
- % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
- }%
- %
- % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
- \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
- \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
- {%
- % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
- % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
- % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
- % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
- % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
- % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
- % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
- % one has made identifiers using them :).
- \df \tt
- \def\temp{#2}% return value type
- \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
- #3% output function name
- }%
- {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
- %
- \boldbrax
- % arguments will be output next, if any.
-}
-
-% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
-% tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
-% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
-% distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
-%
-\def\defunargs#1{%
- % use sl by default (not ttsl),
- % tt for the names.
- \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
- %
- % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
- % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
- \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
- #1%
- \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
-}
-
-% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
-%
-\def\activeparens{%
- \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
- \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
- \catcode`\&=\active
-}
-
-% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
-\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
-
-% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
-% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
-% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
-{
- \activeparens
- \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
- \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
- \global\let& = \&
-
- \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
- \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
-}
-
-\newcount\parencount
-
-% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
-\newif\ifampseen
-\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
-
-\def\parenfont{%
- \ifampseen
- % At the first level, print parens in roman,
- % otherwise use the default font.
- \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
- \else
- % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
- % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
- \sf
- \fi
-}
-\def\infirstlevel#1{%
- \ifampseen
- \ifnum\parencount=1
- #1%
- \fi
- \fi
-}
-\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
-
-\def\opnr{%
- \global\advance\parencount by 1
- {\parenfont(}%
- \infirstlevel \bfafterword
-}
-\def\clnr{%
- {\parenfont)}%
- \infirstlevel \sl
- \global\advance\parencount by -1
-}
-
-\newcount\brackcount
-\def\lbrb{%
- \global\advance\brackcount by 1
- {\bf[}%
-}
-\def\rbrb{%
- {\bf]}%
- \global\advance\brackcount by -1
-}
-
-\def\checkparencounts{%
- \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
- \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
-}
-% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
-% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
-\def\badparencount{%
- \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
- \global\parencount=0
-}
-\def\badbrackcount{%
- \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
- \global\brackcount=0
-}
-
-
-\message{macros,}
-% @macro.
-
-% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
-% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
-\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
- \newwrite\macscribble
- \def\scantokens#1{%
- \toks0={#1}%
- \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
- \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
- \immediate\closeout\macscribble
- \input \jobname.tmp
- }
-\fi
-
-\def\scanmacro#1{%
- \begingroup
- \newlinechar`\^^M
- \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
- % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
- % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
- % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
- % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
- % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
- \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
- % ... and \example
- \spaceisspace
- %
- % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
- % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
- % --kasal, 29nov03
- \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
- \endgroup
-}
-
-\def\scanexp#1{%
- \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
- \temp
-}
-
-\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
-\newtoks\macname % Macro name
-\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
-
-% List of all defined macros in the form
-% \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
-% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
-% if there is a need.
-\def\macrolist{}
-
-% Add the macro to \macrolist
-\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
-\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
- \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
-}
-
-% Utility routines.
-% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
-% \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
-% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
-%
-\def\cslet#1#2{%
- \expandafter\let
- \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
- \csname#2\endcsname
-}
-
-% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
-% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
-{\catcode`\@=11
-\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
-\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
-\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
-\def\unbrace#1{#1}
-\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
-}
-
-% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
-{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
-\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
-\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
-\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
-}
-
-% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
-% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
-% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
-
-% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
-% them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
-% confine the change to the current group.
-
-% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
-% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
-% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
-
-\def\scanctxt{%
- \catcode`\"=\other
- \catcode`\+=\other
- \catcode`\<=\other
- \catcode`\>=\other
- \catcode`\@=\other
- \catcode`\^=\other
- \catcode`\_=\other
- \catcode`\|=\other
- \catcode`\~=\other
- \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
-}
-
-\def\scanargctxt{%
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\\=\other
- \catcode`\^^M=\other
-}
-
-\def\macrobodyctxt{%
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\{=\other
- \catcode`\}=\other
- \catcode`\^^M=\other
- \usembodybackslash
-}
-
-\def\macroargctxt{%
- \scanctxt
- \catcode`\\=\other
-}
-
-% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
-% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
-% where N is the macro parameter number.
-% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
-% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
-
-{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
- @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
- @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
-}
-\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
-
-\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
-\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
-
-\def\macroxxx#1{%
- \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
- \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
- \paramno=0%
- \else
- \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
- \fi
- \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
- \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
- \else
- \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
- \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
- \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
- \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
- \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
- \fi
- \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
- \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
- \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
- \fi}
-
-\parseargdef\unmacro{%
- \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
- \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
- \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
- % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
- \begingroup
- \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
- \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
- \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
- \endgroup
- \else
- \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
-% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
-%
-\def\unmacrodo#1{%
- \ifx #1\relax
- % remove this
- \else
- \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
- \fi
-}
-
-% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
-% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
-% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
-\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
-\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
-\def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
-\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
-
-% Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
-% so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
-% in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
-% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
-
-% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
-% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
-% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
-% it to # just before using the token list produced.
-%
-% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
-% the macro is used.
-
-\def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
- \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
-\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
- \if#1;\let\next=\relax
- \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
- \advance\paramno by 1%
- \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
- {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
- \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
- \fi\next}
-
-% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
-% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
-
-\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
-{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
-\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
-{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
-
-% This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
-% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
-% Much magic with \expandafter here.
-% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
-% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
-\def\defmacro{%
- \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
- \ifrecursive
- \ifcase\paramno
- % 0
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
- \or % 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
- \noexpand\braceorline
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
- \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
- \else % many
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
- \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\xdef
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
- \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
- \fi
- \else
- \ifcase\paramno
- % 0
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
- \or % 1
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
- \noexpand\braceorline
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
- \egroup
- \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
- \else % many
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
- \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\xdef
- \expandafter\expandafter
- \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
- \paramlist{%
- \egroup
- \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
- \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
- \fi
- \fi}
-
-\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
-
-% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
-% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
-% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
-% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
-\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
-\def\braceorlinexxx{%
- \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
- \expandafter\parsearg
- \fi \macnamexxx}
-
-
-% @alias.
-% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
-% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
-\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
-\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
-\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
- {%
- \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
- \addtomacrolist{#1}%
- \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
- }%
- \next
-}
-
-
-\message{cross references,}
-
-\newwrite\auxfile
-\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
-\newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
-
-% @inforef is relatively simple.
-\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
-\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
- node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
-
-% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
-% cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
-% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
-% @node foo , bar , ...
-% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
-%
-\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
-%
-% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
-% @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
-\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
-\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
-
-\let\nwnode=\node
-\let\lastnode=\empty
-
-% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
-% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
-%
-\def\donoderef#1{%
- \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
- \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
- \global\let\lastnode=\empty
- \fi
-}
-
-% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
-%
-\newcount\savesfregister
-%
-\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
-\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
-\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
-
-% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
-% anchor), which consists of three parts:
-% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
-% or the anchor name.
-% 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
-% empty for anchors.
-% 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
-%
-% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
-% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
-% 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
-%
-\def\setref#1#2{%
- \pdfmkdest{#1}%
- \iflinks
- {%
- \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
- \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
- \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
- ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
- }%
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
- \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
- \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
- \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
- }%
- \fi
-}
-
-% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
-% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
-% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
-% manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
-%
-\def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
-\def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
-\def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
-\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
- \unsepspaces
- \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
- \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
- \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
- \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
- % No printed node name was explicitly given.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
- % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
- \else
- % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
- % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
- % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
- \else
- \ifhavexrefs
- % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
- \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
- \else
- % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
- \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
- \fi%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- %
- % Make link in pdf output.
- \ifpdf
- {\indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
- % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.
- \getfilename{#4}%
- %
- % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
- {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
- \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
- %
- \leavevmode
- \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
- \ifnum\filenamelength>0
- goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
- \else
- goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
- \fi
- }%
- \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
- \fi
- %
- % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
- % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
- % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
- {%
- % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
- % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
- \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
- }%
- \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
- % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
- % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
- \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
- \refx{#1-snt}{}%
- \else
- \printedrefname
- \fi
- %
- % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
- % "in MANUALNAME".
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
- \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
- \fi
- \else
- % node/anchor (non-float) references.
- %
- % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
- % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
- % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
- % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
- % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
- % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
- \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
- \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
- \else
- % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
- % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
- % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
- % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
- % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
- {\turnoffactive
- % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
- % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
- \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
- \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
- }%
- % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
- \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
- %
- % But we always want a comma and a space:
- ,\space
- %
- % output the `page 3'.
- \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \endlink
-\endgroup}
-
-% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
-% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
-% since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
-% one that Bob is working on :).
-%
-\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
-
-% Things referred to by \setref.
-%
-\def\Ynothing{}
-\def\Yomitfromtoc{}
-\def\Ynumbered{%
- \ifnum\secno=0
- \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
- \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
- \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
- \else
- \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-\def\Yappendix{%
- \ifnum\secno=0
- \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
- \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
- \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
- \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
- \else
- \putwordSection@tie
- @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
- \fi\fi\fi
-}
-
-% Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
-% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
-%
-\def\refx#1#2{%
- {%
- \indexnofonts
- \otherbackslash
- \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
- \csname XR#1\endcsname
- }%
- \ifx\thisrefX\relax
- % If not defined, say something at least.
- \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
- \iflinks
- \ifhavexrefs
- \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
- \else
- \ifwarnedxrefs\else
- \global\warnedxrefstrue
- \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- % It's defined, so just use it.
- \thisrefX
- \fi
- #2% Output the suffix in any case.
-}
-
-% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
-% just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
-% collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
-%
-\def\xrdef#1#2{%
- {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
- % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
- % mess up the control sequence name.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
- }%
- %
- \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
- %
- % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
- \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
- % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
- \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
- \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
- %
- % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
- \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
- \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
- \else
- % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
- \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
- \fi
- %
- % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
- % for later use in \listoffloats.
- \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
- {\safexrefname}}%
- \fi
-}
-
-% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
-%
-\def\tryauxfile{%
- \openin 1 \jobname.aux
- \ifeof 1 \else
- \readdatafile{aux}%
- \global\havexrefstrue
- \fi
- \closein 1
-}
-
-\def\setupdatafile{%
- \catcode`\^^@=\other
- \catcode`\^^A=\other
- \catcode`\^^B=\other
- \catcode`\^^C=\other
- \catcode`\^^D=\other
- \catcode`\^^E=\other
- \catcode`\^^F=\other
- \catcode`\^^G=\other
- \catcode`\^^H=\other
- \catcode`\^^K=\other
- \catcode`\^^L=\other
- \catcode`\^^N=\other
- \catcode`\^^P=\other
- \catcode`\^^Q=\other
- \catcode`\^^R=\other
- \catcode`\^^S=\other
- \catcode`\^^T=\other
- \catcode`\^^U=\other
- \catcode`\^^V=\other
- \catcode`\^^W=\other
- \catcode`\^^X=\other
- \catcode`\^^Z=\other
- \catcode`\^^[=\other
- \catcode`\^^\=\other
- \catcode`\^^]=\other
- \catcode`\^^^=\other
- \catcode`\^^_=\other
- % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
- % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
- % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
- % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
- % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
- % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
- % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
- % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
- %
- % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
- % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
- % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
- %
- \catcode`\^=\other
- %
- % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
- \catcode`\~=\other
- \catcode`\[=\other
- \catcode`\]=\other
- \catcode`\"=\other
- \catcode`\_=\other
- \catcode`\|=\other
- \catcode`\<=\other
- \catcode`\>=\other
- \catcode`\$=\other
- \catcode`\#=\other
- \catcode`\&=\other
- \catcode`\%=\other
- \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
- %
- % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
- % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
- % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
- % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
- % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
- % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
- % now. --karl, 15jan04.
- \catcode`\\=\other
- %
- % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
- {%
- \count1=128
- \def\loop{%
- \catcode\count1=\other
- \advance\count1 by 1
- \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
- }%
- }%
- %
- % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
- \catcode`\{=1
- \catcode`\}=2
- \catcode`\@=0
-}
-
-\def\readdatafile#1{%
-\begingroup
- \setupdatafile
- \input\jobname.#1
-\endgroup}
-
-
-\message{insertions,}
-% including footnotes.
-
-\newcount \footnoteno
-
-% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
-% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
-% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
-% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
-% space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
-\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
-
-% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
-\let\footnotestyle=\comment
-
-{\catcode `\@=11
-%
-% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
-\gdef\footnote{%
- \let\indent=\ptexindent
- \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
- \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
- \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
- %
- % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
- % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
- \let\@sf\empty
- \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
- %
- % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
- \unskip
- \thisfootno\@sf
- \dofootnote
-}%
-
-% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
-% footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
-%
-% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
-% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
-% the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
-%
-\gdef\dofootnote{%
- \insert\footins\bgroup
- % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
- % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
- % So reset some parameters.
- \hsize=\pagewidth
- \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
- \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
- \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
- \floatingpenalty\@MM
- \leftskip\z@skip
- \rightskip\z@skip
- \spaceskip\z@skip
- \xspaceskip\z@skip
- \parindent\defaultparindent
- %
- \smallfonts \rm
- %
- % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
- % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
- % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
- % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
- \let\noindent = \relax
- %
- % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
- % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
- \everypar = {\hang}%
- \textindent{\thisfootno}%
- %
- % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
- % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
- % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
- \footstrut
- \futurelet\next\fo@t
-}
-}%end \catcode `\@=11
-
-% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
-% the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
-% would be lost.
-% Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
-% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
-% And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
-
-% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
-% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
-% out prematurely.
-%
-\def\startsavinginserts{%
- \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
- \let\insert\saveinsert
- \else
- \let\checkinserts\relax
- \fi
-}
-
-% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
-% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
-%
-\def\saveinsert#1{%
- \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
- \afterassignment\next
- % swallow the left brace
- \let\temp =
-}
-\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
-\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
-
-\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
-
-\def\placesaveins#1{%
- \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
- {\box#1}%
-}
-
-% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
-{
- \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
- \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
-}
-
-% initialization:
-\def\newsaveins #1{%
- \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
- \next
-}
-\def\newsaveinsX #1{%
- \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
- \checksaveins #1}%
-}
-
-% initialize:
-\let\checkinserts\empty
-\newsaveins\footins
-\newsaveins\margin
-
-
-% @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
-% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
-%
-% Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
-% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
-% undone and the next image would fail.
-\openin 1 = epsf.tex
-\ifeof 1 \else
- % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
- % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
- \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
- \input epsf.tex
-\fi
-\closein 1
-%
-% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
-\newif\ifwarnednoepsf
-\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
- work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
- it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
-%
-\def\image#1{%
- \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
- \ifwarnednoepsf \else
- \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
- \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
- \global\warnednoepsftrue
- \fi
- \else
- \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
- \fi
-}
-%
-% Arguments to @image:
-% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
-% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
-% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
-% #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
-% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
-\newif\ifimagevmode
-\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
- \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
- \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
- % If the image is by itself, center it.
- \ifvmode
- \imagevmodetrue
- \nobreak\medskip
- % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
- % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
- % above and below.
- \nobreak\vskip\parskip
- \nobreak
- \fi
- %
- % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
- % environment such as @quotation is respected. On the other hand, if
- % it's at the top level, we don't want the normal paragraph indentation.
- \noindent
- %
- % Output the image.
- \ifpdf
- \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
- \else
- % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
- \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
- \fi
- %
- \ifimagevmode \medskip \fi % space after the standalone image
-\endgroup}
-
-
-% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
-% etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
-% float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
-%
-\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
-
-% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
-\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
-
-% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
-% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
-% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
-%
-% #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
-% be referable.
-%
-% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
-% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
-%
-% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
-% chapter-level command.
-\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
-%
-\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
- \let\thiscaption=\empty
- \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
- %
- % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
- %
- % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
- % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
- %
- \startsavinginserts
- %
- % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
- \par
- %
- \vtop\bgroup
- \def\floattype{#1}%
- \def\floatlabel{#2}%
- \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
- %
- \ifx\floattype\empty
- \let\safefloattype=\empty
- \else
- {%
- % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
- % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
- }%
- \fi
- %
- % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
- \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
- % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
- % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
- %
- \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
- \global\advance\floatno by 1
- %
- {%
- % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
- % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
- % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
- % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
- % lists of floats.
- %
- \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
- \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
- }%
- \fi
- %
- % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
- \vskip\parskip
- %
- % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
- \restorefirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% we have these possibilities:
-% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
-% @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
-% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
-% @float Foo & no caption: Foo
-% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
-% @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
-% @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
-% @float & no caption:
-%
-\def\Efloat{%
- \let\floatident = \empty
- %
- % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
- \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
- %
- % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
- \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
- \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
- \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
- \fi
- % the number.
- \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
- \fi
- %
- % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
- % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
- \let\captionline = \floatident
- %
- \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
- \ifx\floatident\empty \else
- \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
- \fi
- %
- % caption text.
- \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
- \fi
- %
- % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
- % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
- \ifx\captionline\empty \else
- \vskip.5\parskip
- \captionline
- %
- % Space below caption.
- \vskip\parskip
- \fi
- %
- % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
- % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
- \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
- % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
- % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
- % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
- {%
- \atdummies
- %
- % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
- % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
- % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
- \scanexp{%
- \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
- \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
- \thiscaption
- \else
- \thisshortcaption
- \fi
- }%
- }%
- \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
- \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
- }%
- \fi
- \egroup % end of \vtop
- %
- % place the captured inserts
- %
- % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
- % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
- % float. --kasal, 26may04
- %
- \checkinserts
-}
-
-% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
-%
-\def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
- \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
-}
-
-% @caption, @shortcaption
-%
-\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
-\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
-\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
-\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
-
-% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
-% going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
-\def\getfloatno#1{%
- \ifx#1\relax
- % Haven't seen this figure type before.
- \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
- %
- % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
- \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
- \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
- \fi
- \let\floatno#1%
-}
-
-% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
-% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
-% first read the @float command.
-%
-\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
-
-% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
-% distinguish floats from other xref types.
-\def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
-
-% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
-% which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
-% \lastsection value which we \setref above.
-%
-\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
-%
-% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
-% (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
-%
-\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
- \def\temp{#1}%
- \def\iffloattype{#2}%
- \ifx\temp\floatmagic
-}
-
-% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
-%
-\parseargdef\listoffloats{%
- \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
- {%
- % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
- % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
- \indexnofonts
- \turnoffactive
- \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
- }%
- %
- % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
- \ifhavexrefs
- % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
- \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
- \fi
- \else
- \begingroup
- \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
- \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
- \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
- \endgroup
- \fi
-}
-
-% This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
-% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
-% aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
-% has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
-%
-% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
-% they won't appear in the aux file).
-%
-\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
-\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
- % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
- % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
- % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
- % in pdf output.
- \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
- %
- % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
- \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
- \writeentry
-}}
-
-
-\message{localization,}
-
-% For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
-% early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
-% (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
-%
-{
- \catcode`\_ = \active
- \globaldefs=1
-\parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
- \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
- \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
- % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
- \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
- \ifeof 1
- \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
- \else
- \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
- \input txi-#1.tex
- \fi
- \closein 1
- \endgroup % end raw TeX
-\endgroup}
-%
-% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
-% try txi-de.tex.
-%
-\gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
- \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
- \ifeof 1
- \errhelp = \nolanghelp
- \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
- \else
- \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
- \input txi-#1.tex
- \fi
- \closein 1
-}
-}% end of special _ catcode
-%
-\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
-is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
-directory should work if nowhere else does.}
-
-% This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
-% \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
-% third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
-%
-% The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
-% See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
-% /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
-%
-% With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
-% available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
-% Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
-% accented characters problem.)
-%
-\catcode`@=11
-\def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
- % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
- \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
- \message{no patterns for #1}%
- \else
- \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
- \fi
- % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
- \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
- \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
-}
-
-% Helpers for encodings.
-% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
-%
-\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
- \count255=128
- \loop\ifnum\count255<256
- \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
- \advance\count255 by 1
- \repeat
-}
-
-\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
- \count255=128
- \loop\ifnum\count255<256
- \catcode\count255=#1\relax
- \advance\count255 by 1
- \repeat
-}
-
-% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
-% according to the specified encoding.
-%
-\parseargdef\documentencoding{%
- % Encoding being declared for the document.
- \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
- %
- % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
- % to compare them with \ifx.
- \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
- \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
- %
- \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
- \asciichardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \lattwochardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \latonechardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \latninechardefs
- %
- \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
- \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
- \utfeightchardefs
- %
- \else
- \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
- %
- \fi % utfeight
- \fi % latnine
- \fi % latone
- \fi % lattwo
- \fi % ascii
-}
-
-% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
-% the default font encoding (OT1).
-%
-\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
-
-% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
-\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
-
-% First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
-% correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
-% macros containing the character definitions.
-\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-%
-% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
-\def\latonechardefs{%
- \gdef^^a0{~}
- \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
- \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
- \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
- \gdef^^a7{\S}
- \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
- \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
- \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
- \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft}
- \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
- \gdef^^ad{\-}
- \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
- \gdef^^af{\={}}
- %
- \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
- \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
- \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
- \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
- \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
- \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
- \gdef^^b6{\P}
- %
- \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
- \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
- \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
- \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
- %
- \gdef^^bb{\guilletright}
- \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
- \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
- \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
- \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
- %
- \gdef^^c0{\`A}
- \gdef^^c1{\'A}
- \gdef^^c2{\^A}
- \gdef^^c3{\~A}
- \gdef^^c4{\"A}
- \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
- \gdef^^c6{\AE}
- \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
- \gdef^^c8{\`E}
- \gdef^^c9{\'E}
- \gdef^^ca{\^E}
- \gdef^^cb{\"E}
- \gdef^^cc{\`I}
- \gdef^^cd{\'I}
- \gdef^^ce{\^I}
- \gdef^^cf{\"I}
- %
- \gdef^^d0{\DH}
- \gdef^^d1{\~N}
- \gdef^^d2{\`O}
- \gdef^^d3{\'O}
- \gdef^^d4{\^O}
- \gdef^^d5{\~O}
- \gdef^^d6{\"O}
- \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
- \gdef^^d8{\O}
- \gdef^^d9{\`U}
- \gdef^^da{\'U}
- \gdef^^db{\^U}
- \gdef^^dc{\"U}
- \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
- \gdef^^de{\TH}
- \gdef^^df{\ss}
- %
- \gdef^^e0{\`a}
- \gdef^^e1{\'a}
- \gdef^^e2{\^a}
- \gdef^^e3{\~a}
- \gdef^^e4{\"a}
- \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
- \gdef^^e6{\ae}
- \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
- \gdef^^e8{\`e}
- \gdef^^e9{\'e}
- \gdef^^ea{\^e}
- \gdef^^eb{\"e}
- \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
- \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
- \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
- \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
- %
- \gdef^^f0{\dh}
- \gdef^^f1{\~n}
- \gdef^^f2{\`o}
- \gdef^^f3{\'o}
- \gdef^^f4{\^o}
- \gdef^^f5{\~o}
- \gdef^^f6{\"o}
- \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
- \gdef^^f8{\o}
- \gdef^^f9{\`u}
- \gdef^^fa{\'u}
- \gdef^^fb{\^u}
- \gdef^^fc{\"u}
- \gdef^^fd{\'y}
- \gdef^^fe{\th}
- \gdef^^ff{\"y}
-}
-
-% Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
-\def\latninechardefs{%
- % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
- \latonechardefs
- %
- \gdef^^a4{\euro}
- \gdef^^a6{\v S}
- \gdef^^a8{\v s}
- \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
- \gdef^^b8{\v z}
- \gdef^^bc{\OE}
- \gdef^^bd{\oe}
- \gdef^^be{\"Y}
-}
-
-% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
-\def\lattwochardefs{%
- \gdef^^a0{~}
- \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
- \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
- \gdef^^a3{\L}
- \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
- \gdef^^a5{\v L}
- \gdef^^a6{\'S}
- \gdef^^a7{\S}
- \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
- \gdef^^a9{\v S}
- \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
- \gdef^^ab{\v T}
- \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
- \gdef^^ad{\-}
- \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
- \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
- %
- \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
- \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
- \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
- \gdef^^b3{\l}
- \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
- \gdef^^b5{\v l}
- \gdef^^b6{\'s}
- \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
- \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
- \gdef^^b9{\v s}
- \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
- \gdef^^bb{\v t}
- \gdef^^bc{\'z}
- \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
- \gdef^^be{\v z}
- \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
- %
- \gdef^^c0{\'R}
- \gdef^^c1{\'A}
- \gdef^^c2{\^A}
- \gdef^^c3{\u A}
- \gdef^^c4{\"A}
- \gdef^^c5{\'L}
- \gdef^^c6{\'C}
- \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
- \gdef^^c8{\v C}
- \gdef^^c9{\'E}
- \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
- \gdef^^cb{\"E}
- \gdef^^cc{\v E}
- \gdef^^cd{\'I}
- \gdef^^ce{\^I}
- \gdef^^cf{\v D}
- %
- \gdef^^d0{\DH}
- \gdef^^d1{\'N}
- \gdef^^d2{\v N}
- \gdef^^d3{\'O}
- \gdef^^d4{\^O}
- \gdef^^d5{\H O}
- \gdef^^d6{\"O}
- \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
- \gdef^^d8{\v R}
- \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
- \gdef^^da{\'U}
- \gdef^^db{\H U}
- \gdef^^dc{\"U}
- \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
- \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
- \gdef^^df{\ss}
- %
- \gdef^^e0{\'r}
- \gdef^^e1{\'a}
- \gdef^^e2{\^a}
- \gdef^^e3{\u a}
- \gdef^^e4{\"a}
- \gdef^^e5{\'l}
- \gdef^^e6{\'c}
- \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
- \gdef^^e8{\v c}
- \gdef^^e9{\'e}
- \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
- \gdef^^eb{\"e}
- \gdef^^ec{\v e}
- \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
- \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
- \gdef^^ef{\v d}
- %
- \gdef^^f0{\dh}
- \gdef^^f1{\'n}
- \gdef^^f2{\v n}
- \gdef^^f3{\'o}
- \gdef^^f4{\^o}
- \gdef^^f5{\H o}
- \gdef^^f6{\"o}
- \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
- \gdef^^f8{\v r}
- \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
- \gdef^^fa{\'u}
- \gdef^^fb{\H u}
- \gdef^^fc{\"u}
- \gdef^^fd{\'y}
- \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
- \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
-}
-
-% UTF-8 character definitions.
-%
-% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
-% changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
-% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
-%
-\newcount\countUTFx
-\newcount\countUTFy
-\newcount\countUTFz
-
-\gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
- \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
-%
-\gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
- \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
-%
-\gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
- \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
-
-\gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
- \ifx #1\relax
- \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
- \else
- \expandafter #1%
- \fi
-}
-
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\~13
- \catcode`\"12
-
- \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
- \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
- \uccode`\~\countUTFx
- \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
- \advance\countUTFx by 1
- \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
- \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
- \fi}
-
- \countUTFx = "C2
- \countUTFy = "E0
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
- \UTFviiiLoop
-
- \countUTFx = "E0
- \countUTFy = "F0
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
- \UTFviiiLoop
-
- \countUTFx = "F0
- \countUTFy = "F4
- \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
- \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
- \UTFviiiLoop
-\endgroup
-
-\begingroup
- \catcode`\"=12
- \catcode`\<=12
- \catcode`\.=12
- \catcode`\,=12
- \catcode`\;=12
- \catcode`\!=12
- \catcode`\~=13
-
- \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
- \countUTFz = "#1\relax
- \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
- \begingroup
- \parseXMLCharref
- \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
- \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
- \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
- \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
- \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
- \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
- \endgroup}
-
- \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
- \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
- \errhelp = \EMsimple
- \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
- \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
- \parseUTFviiiA,%
- \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
- \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
- \parseUTFviiiA;%
- \parseUTFviiiA,%
- \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
- \else
- \parseUTFviiiA;%
- \parseUTFviiiA,%
- \parseUTFviiiA!%
- \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
- \fi\fi\fi
- }
-
- \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
- \countUTFx = \countUTFz
- \divide\countUTFz by 64
- \countUTFy = \countUTFz
- \multiply\countUTFz by 64
- \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
- \advance\countUTFx by 128
- \uccode `#1\countUTFx
- \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
-
- \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
- \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
- \uccode `#3\countUTFz
- \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
-\endgroup
-
-\def\utfeightchardefs{%
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
-
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
- \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
-}% end of \utfeightchardefs
-
-
-% US-ASCII character definitions.
-\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
- \relax
-}
-
-% Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
-% existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
-% document encoding.
-%
-\setnonasciicharscatcode \other
-
-
-\message{formatting,}
-
-\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
-
-\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
-\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
-\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
-
-% Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
-\vbadness = 10000
-
-% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
-\hbadness = 2000
-
-% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
-\widowpenalty=10000
-\clubpenalty=10000
-
-% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
-% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
-% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
-% \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
-%
-\def\setemergencystretch{%
- \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
- % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
- \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
- \else
- \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
- \fi
-}
-
-% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
-% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
-% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
-%
-% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
-% \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
-%
-\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
- \voffset = #3\relax
- \topskip = #6\relax
- \splittopskip = \topskip
- %
- \vsize = #1\relax
- \advance\vsize by \topskip
- \outervsize = \vsize
- \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
- \pageheight = \vsize
- %
- \hsize = #2\relax
- \outerhsize = \hsize
- \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
- \pagewidth = \hsize
- %
- \normaloffset = #4\relax
- \bindingoffset = #5\relax
- %
- \ifpdf
- \pdfpageheight #7\relax
- \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
- % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
- % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
- \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
- \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
- \fi
- %
- \setleading{\textleading}
- %
- \parindent = \defaultparindent
- \setemergencystretch
-}
-
-% @letterpaper (the default).
-\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \textleading = 13.2pt
- %
- % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
- \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
- {\voffset}{.25in}%
- {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
- {11in}{8.5in}%
-}}
-
-% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
-\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
- \textleading = 12pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
- {-.2in}{0in}%
- {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
- {9.25in}{7in}%
- %
- \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
- \tolerance = 700
- \hfuzz = 1pt
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = .5cm
-}}
-
-% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
-% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
-\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
- \textleading = 12pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
- {-.2in}{-.4in}%
- {0pt}{14pt}%
- {9in}{6in}%
- %
- \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
- \tolerance = 700
- \hfuzz = 1pt
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = .4cm
-}}
-
-% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
-\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \textleading = 13.2pt
- %
- % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
- % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
- % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
- % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
- % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
- % your texinfo source file like this:
- % @tex
- % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
- % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
- % @end tex
- \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
- {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
- {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
- {297mm}{210mm}%
- %
- \tolerance = 700
- \hfuzz = 1pt
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = 5mm
-}}
-
-% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
-% From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
-% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
-\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
- \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
- \textleading = 12.5pt
- %
- \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
- {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
- {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
- {210mm}{148mm}%
- %
- \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
- \tolerance = 800
- \hfuzz = 1.2pt
- \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
- \defbodyindent = 2mm
- \tableindent = 12mm
-}}
-
-% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
-\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
- \afourpaper
- \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
- {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
- {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
- {297mm}{210mm}%
- %
- % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
- \globaldefs = 0
-}}
-
-% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
-\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
- \afourpaper
- \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
- {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
- {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
- {297mm}{210mm}%
- \globaldefs = 0
-}}
-
-% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
-% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
-% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
-%
-\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
-\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
- \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
- \globaldefs = 1
- %
- \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
- \setleading{\textleading}%
- %
- \dimen0 = #1\relax
- \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
- %
- \dimen2 = \hsize
- \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
- %
- \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
- {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
- {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
- {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
-}}
-
-% Set default to letter.
-%
-\letterpaper
-
-
-\message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
-
-% DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
-\catcode`\^^? = 14
-
-% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
-\catcode`\"=\other
-\catcode`\~=\other
-\catcode`\^=\other
-\catcode`\_=\other
-\catcode`\|=\other
-\catcode`\<=\other
-\catcode`\>=\other
-\catcode`\+=\other
-\catcode`\$=\other
-\def\normaldoublequote{"}
-\def\normaltilde{~}
-\def\normalcaret{^}
-\def\normalunderscore{_}
-\def\normalverticalbar{|}
-\def\normalless{<}
-\def\normalgreater{>}
-\def\normalplus{+}
-\def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
-
-% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
-% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
-% where something hairier probably needs to be done.
-%
-% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
-% otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
-% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
-% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
-%
-\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
-
-% Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
-% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
-% italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
-% this is not a problem.
-\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
-
-% Turn off all special characters except @
-% (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
-% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
-% use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
-
-\catcode`\"=\active
-\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
-\let"=\activedoublequote
-\catcode`\~=\active
-\def~{{\tt\char126}}
-\chardef\hat=`\^
-\catcode`\^=\active
-\def^{{\tt \hat}}
-
-\catcode`\_=\active
-\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
-\let\realunder=_
-% Subroutine for the previous macro.
-\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
-
-\catcode`\|=\active
-\def|{{\tt\char124}}
-\chardef \less=`\<
-\catcode`\<=\active
-\def<{{\tt \less}}
-\chardef \gtr=`\>
-\catcode`\>=\active
-\def>{{\tt \gtr}}
-\catcode`\+=\active
-\def+{{\tt \char 43}}
-\catcode`\$=\active
-\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
-
-% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
-% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
-% So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
-% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
-\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
-
-% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
-% parsing them.
-\def\turnoffactive{%
- \normalturnoffactive
- \otherbackslash
-}
-
-\catcode`\@=0
-
-% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
-% as in \char`\\.
-\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
-\global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
-
-% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
-% \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
-{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
-
-% In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
-% in fixed width font.
-\catcode`\\=\active
-@def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
-% On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
-% @let \ = @normalbackslash
-
-% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
-% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
-% catcode other.
-@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
-@gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
-
-% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
-% the literal character `\'.
-%
-@def@normalturnoffactive{%
- @let\=@normalbackslash
- @let"=@normaldoublequote
- @let~=@normaltilde
- @let^=@normalcaret
- @let_=@normalunderscore
- @let|=@normalverticalbar
- @let<=@normalless
- @let>=@normalgreater
- @let+=@normalplus
- @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
- @markupsetuplqdefault
- @markupsetuprqdefault
- @unsepspaces
-}
-
-% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
-% This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
-@otherifyactive
-
-% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
-% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
-% a backslash.
-%
-@gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
-@global@let\ = @eatinput
-
-% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
-% the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
-% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
-% Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
-% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
-%
-@gdef@fixbackslash{%
- @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
- @catcode`+=@active
- @catcode`@_=@active
-}
-
-% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
-@escapechar = `@@
-
-% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
-@catcode`@& = @other
-@catcode`@# = @other
-@catcode`@% = @other
-
-@c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
-@c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
-@c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
-@c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
-@catcode`@'=@active
-@catcode`@`=@active
-@markupsetuplqdefault
-@markupsetuprqdefault
-
-@c Local variables:
-@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
-@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
-@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
-@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-@c time-stamp-end: "}"
-@c End:
-
-@c vim:sw=2:
-
-@ignore
- arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
-@end ignore
diff --git a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/tutorial.texi b/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/tutorial.texi
deleted file mode 100644
index 941fa2869d..0000000000
--- a/lib/libmicrohttpd/doc/tutorial.texi
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,147 +0,0 @@
-\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
-@finalout
-@setfilename microhttpd-tutorial.info
-@settitle A tutorial for GNU libmicrohttpd
-@afourpaper
-
-@set VERSION 0.4.0
-
-@dircategory GNU Libraries
-@direntry
-* libmicrohttpdtutorial: (microhttpd). A tutorial for GNU libmicrohttpd.
-@end direntry
-
-@titlepage
-@title A Tutorial for GNU libmicrohttpd
-@subtitle written for version @value{VERSION}
-@author Sebastian Gerhardt (@email{sebgerhardt@@gmx.net})
-@page
-@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
-@end titlepage
-
-@verbatim
-Copyright (c) 2008 Sebastian Gerhardt.
-Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
-under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
-or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
-with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover
-Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU
-Free Documentation License".
-@end verbatim
-
-@contents
-
-@ifnottex
-@node Top
-@top Top
-@end ifnottex
-
-@menu
-* Introduction::
-* Hello browser example::
-* Exploring requests::
-* Response headers::
-* Supporting basic authentication::
-* Processing POST data::
-* Improved processing of POST data::
-* Adding a layer of security::
-* Bibliography::
-* License text::
-* Example programs::
-@end menu
-
-@node Introduction
-@chapter Introduction
-@include chapters/introduction.inc
-
-@node Hello browser example
-@chapter Hello browser example
-@include chapters/hellobrowser.inc
-
-@node Exploring requests
-@chapter Exploring requests
-@include chapters/exploringrequests.inc
-
-@node Response headers
-@chapter Response headers
-@include chapters/responseheaders.inc
-
-@node Supporting basic authentication
-@chapter Supporting basic authentication
-@include chapters/basicauthentication.inc
-
-@node Processing POST data
-@chapter Processing POST data
-@include chapters/processingpost.inc
-
-@node Improved processing of POST data
-@chapter Improved processing of POST data
-@include chapters/largerpost.inc
-
-@node Adding a layer of security
-@chapter Adding a layer of security
-@include chapters/tlsauthentication.inc
-
-@node Bibliography
-@appendix Bibliography
-@include chapters/bibliography.inc
-
-@node License text
-@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
-@include fdl-1.3.texi
-
-@node Example programs
-@appendix Example programs
-@menu
-* hellobrowser.c::
-* logging.c::
-* responseheaders.c::
-* basicauthentication.c::
-* simplepost.c::
-* largepost.c::
-* tlsauthentication.c::
-@end menu
-
-@node hellobrowser.c
-@section hellobrowser.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/hellobrowser.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@node logging.c
-@section logging.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/logging.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@node responseheaders.c
-@section responseheaders.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/responseheaders.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@node basicauthentication.c
-@section basicauthentication.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/basicauthentication.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@node simplepost.c
-@section simplepost.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/simplepost.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@node largepost.c
-@section largepost.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/largepost.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@node tlsauthentication.c
-@section tlsauthentication.c
-@smalldisplay
-@verbatiminclude examples/tlsauthentication.c
-@end smalldisplay
-
-@bye